General Honsberg PDF
General Honsberg PDF
General Honsberg PDF
Main Catalogue
Agent
Flow
Level
Temperature
Pressure
Filtration
Basic
Welcome to Honsberg!
As a familiy controlled enterprise, we welcome you and
appreciate your interest in
our products for control and
measurement of flow, level,
temperature, pressure and
filtration.
Sincerely
M. Seulen
Owner Manager
Basic
1963
1974
1977
1980
1990
1995
1996
1998
2000
2002
2004
2005
15
51
Variable area
99
127
Rotor, turbine,
gear and oval wheel
Monitoring, indicating,
metering, counting
161
Calorimetric,magneticinductive, vortex
Monitoring, metering
201
Indicating
223
Orifice
Regulation, monitoring
235
Level
243
Temperature
269
Pressure
279
Integrated systems
Omni/Flex
297
Transducers
Signal processing
311
Filters, accessories
321
The range
Flow
Level
Temperature
Pressure
Basic
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
engineering
customized solutions, oem
(enduser)
process application
miscellaneous
1.
2.
3.
4.
flow
level
temperature
pressure
1. mechanical instrumentation
2. electronic instrumentation
1. domestic market
2. export europe
3. export world
The systems
The HONSBERG range includes metering and monitoring equipment in the accuracy range of up to 0.1 % from the measured
value. HONSBERG technology concentrates on specific mechanical
and electronic systems which are integrated in a variety of
systems, resulting in an extremely flexible range of applications.
Advantages
Disadvantages
Application
Principle
l Sturdy mechanics
l Good repeatability
Piston
spring-supported
(path recording)
l Purely physical
floating principle
l High accuracy
l Low pressure
loss
l Dirt
resistant
l Independent of
nominal diameters
l High accuracy
l Higher functional
tolerance
l Sensitive with
high flow velocities
Universal use
for liquids
and gases
l Industry, e.g.
transfer lines
Metering of
transparent liquids
and gases
l Laboratory
l Medical technology
Yes/no control
of liquid and
gaseous media
l Heating technology
l Transformers
l Limited application
for gases and
viscous media
Linear frequency
signals
l Cooling systems
Rotor, turbine
(rotation)
l High accuracy
l Volumetric,
thus independent
of viscosity
Gear wheel,
oval wheel
(rotation)
l No moving
parts
l Independent of
nominal diameters
l Limited application
for gases and oils
l Inductive only for
conductive liquids
Sensor technology
l Welding robots
l Waste water
systems
l Linear method
l Sensitive to
changes in density
Level monitoring
and metering
l Tanks
Calorimetric,
magnetic,
inductive
(temperature
difference,
inductive)
Level
Float,
sight glass
(path recording)
l Proven method
of monitoring
and metering
temperature
l Linearity
deviation in
the lower range
Temperature
monitoring and
metering
l Industrial systems
l Linear transmission
of motion
l Diaphragm sensitive
to high pressures
Pressure monitoring
and metering
l Gears
Variable area
(path recording)
Paddle
spring-supported
(path recording)
Temperature
diaphragm,
platinum,
resistancesensor
Pressure
Piston, diaphragm,
piezoresistive strain
relief element
Basic
Flow
l/min
Level
mm
Temperature
C
Pressure
bar
The Honsberg technology for monitoring and metering flow, level, temperature and pressure is based on the principle of inductive magnetic
coupling of movement of a spring-supported base or rotating element
fitted with a magnet. This unit is located in the hydraulic area and
actuates contacts, display units or integrated electronic circuits outside
the media space according to specific parameters.
Using this method, switch contacts are triggered, dials actuated,
visual display elements activated or continuous output produced in a
pre-defined position which corresponds to the operating parameter
required.
This technology results in significant advantages during operation:
Spring-supported magnetic
contact control
calorimetric
diaphragm
The components
inductive optical
mag.
inductive
PT 100 piezo
thick film
Display options:
Triggering of mechanical metering
units or digital sensor systems
Component
Task
Design
Advantages
Magnet
Triggering
Ring, cylinder
Inductive
triggering
Spring
Deflection,
reset guarantee
Tension or
Reliable
pressure spring resetting
Reedswitch
Threshold contact,
break contact,
make contact or
changeover contact
Magnetic
triggering
Low hysteresis, no
mechanical triggering
components
Mikroswitch
Threshold contact,
changeover contact
Mechanical
or magnetic
triggering
Hall-Sensor
Sensor signal
PNP
NPN
Magnetic
activation
Metallic
activation
Universal applications,
without magnetic
triggering components
Optical
activation
Sensor without
additional triggering
components
Reliable high-resolution
mechanical scale
system
Inductive
proximity
switch
Optical
sensor
Mechanical
dial unit
Dial display
Integrated
systems
LCD display
Threshold values
0..10 V,
0(4)..20 mA
Handling
One important requirement of product development is simple and safe
product handling. On the one hand, this refers to the installation in
mechanical, electrical and electronic terms, and on the other the calibration and setting of the instruments.
Mechanical installation
The following standard options are available in housing form:
l Female threads
l Flanges
The following standard options are available in stub-connection form:
l Male threads
l Flanges
l Solder, welded stub-connections
Electrical installation
Standard installation of the devices is via plug or cable.
Wiring is according to the connection diagram provided.
Reed, micro-switches
The reed switch consists of contact tongues arranged in a pipe either
evacuated or filled with inert gas, the micro-switch works on the basis
of mechanical contact control.
When connecting the switch it is mandatory that a consumer
is connected in series. It must be guaranteed that the given values
for voltage, current and capacity are not exceeded.
l Switching voltage
l Switching current
l Capacity
V AC
A
VA
Contact material
l Reed switch
l Micro-switch
Reed switch
Electronic sensors
l Inductive proximity switches
l Hall sensors
l Optical sensor
Triggered by metal
Triggered by magnet
Optical triggering
Calibration
The devices can either be factory-adjusted with documentation or calibrated during customer commissioning.
l wear-free
l high responsiveness
Bus applications
The Honsberg oil distribution system is compatible to mostly any BUS
Systems via the "Murr Cube System". Please contact us to get detailed
information.
4..20mA => cube 67 (analog input) =>
Bus interface => reduce 16 wires to one
Basic
The variety
The Honsberg range has an extremely modular structure and
makes flexible adaptation of applications for our devices possible
thanks to the combination of standard components.
Working principle
Piston
Basic device
Monitor
Adjustable contact
of a reed or
micro-switch
Paddle
Monitor
Adjustable contact
of a reed or
micro-switch
Rotor
Frequency-transmitting
transmitter
Calorimetric
Monitor with
LED indication and
potentiometer
setting
Transmitter
with switch PNP or NPN,
4[0]..20 mA or 0 10 V
with and without LCD display
Level
Transmitter with
4 20 mA
Transmitter
with switch PNP or NPN,
4[0]..20 mA or 0 10 V
with and without LCD display
Temperature
Pressure
Variations
Magnetically coupled dial
for local measurement
Sensor options
switch, 4 20 mA output
Integrated transducer
with switch PNP and NPN,
4[0]..20 mA and LCD display
Chapter Systems
Equipment
lA
lD
lE
lF
lF
l Rotor
l Calorimetric
l Magnetic-inductive
lA
lB
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
C
E
E
E
F
F
Variable area
Rotor
Turbine
Gear wheel
Oval wheel
Calorimetric
l FF, FM, G
l FW3, FX, HD1K, HD2K, HM1K, MF,
MR, MR1K, RVM, VF, VO
l GK, GR, MMF, UK, VL
l PO, RL, WR1, RA, RH, RRI, RRH, RRO
l RO
l VHZ
l VHO
l EF
lB
lE
l Variable area
l Turbine
lA
lD
lE
l MXO, MXR, TX
l UB1
l RT
lB
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Aggressive media
NJ,
C
D
E
E
F
F
G
Variable area
Paddle
Rotor
Turbine
Calorimetric
Magnetic-inductive
Sphere
lA
lB
lA
lB
lD
l Paddle
lB
l HD2K, HR1MV
lE
lE
l Gear wheel
l Oval wheel
l VHZ
l VHO
lA
lB
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l Alle
l FX, FW1, HD1K, HR1MV, MF, MI, MR,
MR1K, NJ, NO, VF, VO
l Alle
l UI, UM3K, UR1, UR3K, YR
l PO, WR1, RRI, RRH, RRO
l BL
C
D
E
G
Variable area
Paddle
Rotor
Sphere
Approvals
Chapter Systems
Equipment
Atex
I M1 EEx ia I
II 1G EEx ia IIC T4
II 1D EEx iaD 20 T135
l
l
l
l
l VD, VM
l HD1K, HD1KV, HR1MV
l UR1, VM
l NW1
Atex
II 2G EEx D IIC T6
lA
lD
l VM
l VM
GL - Germanischer Lloyd
lA
lB
l G, VD
l HD1K
TV
lA
lD
lD
l TX
l CRG
l UB1
A
B
D
I
l
l
l
l
Basic
Honsberg at work
Honsberg products can be found in a wide variety of applications and
as original equipment components in industrial plant engineering.
Flow
Level
Application
Compressor
l
l
l
l
l
l dental chair
l diesel engines
l earth moving
machinery
l gearing mechanism
l power generation
l heating engineering
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Paper Machine
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Machine Tool
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
10
clamping cylinder
compressor
construction machines
cooling circuit
cooling unit
Temperature Pressure
Equipment
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
VHZ
FF
NR
RRI
FW1
RRI
MF
G
NR
l NJ, NJV
l VD
l UM3, UR1
UR3
high pressure cleaners l MR
induction hardening
l RRI
equipment
industrial furnaces
l KM
injection moulding
l ZE
machine
laboratory equipment l UK
laser technology
l RRI
machine tool
l MR
medical technology
l MMF
mobile automatic
l FX
welders
multi-circuit system
l RRI
oil circulation
l HD2K
oxygen supply
l MMF
paint finishing system l MR1K
paper machine
l NJ, NJV
printing machine
l FW1, OT
dehumidifier
l UR
pressure increasing
l TF1
system
printing machine
l PM
pollinator
seewage technology
l FIS
steel mill
l UZ
swimming pool
l UR
transformer
l UB1, CM2K
tunelling machine
l omni-F
vacuum pumps
l PM
welding robots
l EFK
Filtration
Chapter / System
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
E gear Wheel
A piston valve design
H level
E rotor
B piston inline design
E rotor
B piston inline design
A piston valve design
H level
C variable area
E rotor
B piston inline design
C float
A piston valve design
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
E rotor
B piston inline design
C variable area
B piston inline design
B piston inline design
B piston inline design
D paddle
J temperature
l K pressure
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
F magnetic-inductive
D paddle
D paddle
D paddle
F calorimetric
K pressure
F calorimetric
Transformers
Paddles
l Monitors oil flow in transformers
l Flow-dependent control of gas valves, combination boilers
l Monitors the addition of chemicals e.g.
in swimming pools
Rotors
l Measures and monitors in semi-conductor technology
l Measures and monitors multi-circuit systems
l Measures and monitors cooling circuits
Semi-conductor industry
Gear wheel
l Hydraulic monitoring of clamping cylinders
Calorimetric
l Monitoring of cooling for welding lance in welding robots
Swimming pools
Variable area
l Monitoring and measurement of water, oil and diesel
in construction machinery
Bi-metal
l Monitoring temperature in booster systems
Welding robots
Diaphragm
l Monitoring of exhaust pressure in vacuum pumps
11
Basic
For many years now, Honsberg has been an established name on the
market for industrial measuring and monitoring systems, and supplies
industrial plant engineering manufacturers with both standard products
and also customised solutions. However, also in this specific market
segment, there are various customer profiles whose needs have to be
individually matched in terms of product portfolio, supply capability, level
of after sales service, etc.
Honsberg customer:
End user
chooses individual items from the complete product range; expects product
advice and delivery at short notice.
Honsberg customer:
Industrial original
equipment manufacturer
Honsberg customer:
Series original
equipment manufacturer
Honsberg customer:
Retailer/distributor
selects certain items from the complete product range in order to include
them in his own sales range. Usually
expects a proprietary label and reliable
delivery. Technical advice plays a less
prominent role.
Honsberg Produktion
Modern machine tools manufacture the Honsberg
specific components.
milling machine
cell assembly
test rig
Basic
Honsberg Digital
All up-to-date information is available as PDF files
on our website www.honsberg.com.
14
Applications
l Industrial metering and monitoring technology
l Cooling systems
l Lubrication circuits
Contents
System description
Advantages
Device system
l Dirt resistant
l High switching capacity
l Various materials
l Nominal diameters DN 8 to DN 300
16
16
17
18
Device descriptions
19
Technical data
Concept
Nominal diameter
8 - 300
Connection
PN
10 - 200
Adjustable
yes
Materials
l Switching
l Indicating
l Metering
15
Basic
System description
Device system
The piston system with valve design is of particular advantage for
metering and monitoring jobs in the area of liquid and gaseous metering materials.
A magnet-equipped piston rests in the valve seat of a housing and is
moved vertically by the flowing medium, whereby the path of the piston
is directly proportional and linear to the flow rate.
No flow
Flow
Since the piston works against the force of a supporting spring,
the devices can be installed in any position and reset safely when
the volume flow diminishes.
Micro-switch
VM
Dial
TZ1
Reed switch
VD
16
Magnetic ring
MP
l
l
l
l
l
Water
VD
VM
MP
TZ1
4
8
10
20
4
8
10
20
4
8
10
20
4
8
10
20
Viscosity mm/s
30
2
6
9
18
4
8
10
19
4
8
10
19
4
8
10
20
60
0.8
4
8
17
4
8
9
18
4
7
9
18
4
7.5
9.5
19
115
0.6
3
6
14
3
7.5
7
17
3
6
8.5
17.5
3.5
7
9
18.5
220
0.25
1.5
3
10
2.5
6
6
14
2
4
8
17
3
6
8
18
MP
VDO
In the case of air and gases, the functional ratio in relation to water
is approx. 1:35, i.e. 1 l/min water corresponds to approx. 35 Nl/min
air, whereby temperature, density and operating pressure play a special
role here.
In these cases the devices are tailor-made according to customer
specifications, whereby the mechanical moving parts are equipped with
additional absorption.
We will be happy to give you special advice in these cases.
Indication
MXR
Type Temperature up to C
160
MXO
160
optional
TX
350
MXO
MXR
17
Basic
VD
TZ1
18
miscellaneous
20
FM
200
90
22
16
80
24
VD
l
l
25 120
100 120
l
l
3
3
3
3
26
28
l
l
100
100
l
l
3
3
3
3
30
32
VDO
100 120
34
MXR
MXO
MXM
100 160
100 160
100 160
l
l
l
3
3
3
3
3
3
36
37
37
350
38
100 100
40
90
90
l
l
3
3
3
3
42
44
46
3
3
3
47
47
47
47
47
47
47
TX
l
l
40
90
90
page
gas/air
aggressive
oil
max. temperature C
on site metering
output signal
water
standard application
indication
200 110
control
l
MP
TZ1
m
m
l
l
l
10
10
10
60
60
60
l
l
l
3
3
3
3
3
3
l
l
l
l
16
16
40
40
120
120
120
120
l
l
l
l
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
16
90
47
16
60
48
16
90
48
PD
special application
connection
type
FF
VM
VD
15 - 100
15 - 300
15 - 300
15 - 150
VM
VI
TZ1
l standard
nominal diameter
flange
flange
flange
flange
bronze
cast iron
cast steel
stainless steel
m standard option
special option
l
l
l
l 100
l 100
l
19
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix FF-...GR
1.1.
FF.GR
FF-025GR040S
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
bronze
200
G 1/4
FF-008GR009.
10
G 3/8
FF-010GR010.
200
15
200
20
G 1/2
FF-015GR012.
40
G 3/4
FF-020GR025.
25
G1
FF-025GR040.
25
60
16
100
G 1 1/4
FF-032GR060.
G 1 1/2
FF-040GR090.
16
150
Switch value is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
L
mm
H
mm
SW
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
0,4 - 9
0,4 - 10
0,4 - 12
0,6 - 25
1,5 - 40
2 - 60
3 - 90
68
68
68
73
87
98
113
79
79
79
79
90
94
95
29
29
29
32
41
52
59
12
12
13
11
14
14
14
0,6
0,6
0,6
0,7
1,0
1,5
2,0
0.3 l/min
max. 110C
0.4 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.4 l/min.
MATERIALS
housing
body
piston
spring
magnet
seals
20
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix FF-...GR
reed switch
230 V AC 1 A 50 VA
cable 1,5 m
protection class IP 65
FF.GR
brown
MOUNTING POSITION
blue
1.1.
green/
yellow
brown
blue
green/
yellow
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
008
010
015
020
025
032
040
G R
Special option
VARIO
009
009
010
012
025
040
060
090
S
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
switch
value
FF-
S
O
Z
Z
Z
0
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 8 - G1/4
nominal diameter DN 10 - G3/8
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 20 - G3/4
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
nominal diameter DN 32 - G1 1/4
nominal diameter DN 40 - G1 1/2
female thread
bronze
selectable range 0.4 - 9 l/min
'selectable range 0,4 - 10 l/min
'selectable range 0,4 - 12 l/min
'selectable range 0,6 - 25 l/min
'selectable range 1,5 - 40 l/min
'selectable range 2 - 60 l/min
'selectable range 3 - 90 l/min
wiring 0.212 n.o.
wiring 0.214 n.c.
switch values for oil or gas
special switch points
nomimal diameter DN 50 - 80
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
21
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix FM-...GR
1.1.
FM.GR
FM-010GR010
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
bonze
200
G 1/4
FM-008GR009
200
FM-010GR010
G 3/8
FM-015GR012
200
G 1/2
Switch value is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
0.3 l/min
max. 90C
0.4 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.5 l/min.
10
15
20
X
mm
weight
kg
0.4 - 9
0.4 - 10
0.4 - 12
12
12
13
0.70
0.65
0.60
option
plug DIN43650-A
MATERIALS
housing
body
piston
spring
magnet
seals
cap
22
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix FM-...GR
1.1.
FM.GR
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
008
010
015
G R
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
009
009
010
012
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
0
switchvalue
FM-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
23
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Minofix G-...GR
1.1.
G.GR
G-015GR
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
bronze
16
G 1/4
G-008GR
4
G-010GR
16
G 3/8
8
G-015GR
G 1/2
16
12
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
X
mm
weight
kg
0.015 - 0.4
0.015 - 0.4
0.015 - 0.4
12
12
13
0.6
0.6
0.6
10 %
max. 80C
0.02 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.2 l/min.
MATERIALS
housing
body
sphere
magnet
seal
24
Basic
piston / valve design
Flow Switch
Minofix G-...GR
1.1.
G.GR
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil up to 20mm/s
NOMENCLATURE
G-
008
008
010
015
G R
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 8 - G1/4
nominal diameter DN 10 - G3/8
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
female thread
bronze
plug DIN 43650-A
cable gland Pg 11 (cable not included)
change over
approval Germanischer Lloyd (GL)
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
special setting
OPTION
plug DIN43650-A
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
25
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix VD-...GR
1.1.
VD.GR
good repeatability
dirt-resistant
exact setting of switch via scale
Q (l/min)
250
200
100-200 l/min
150
50-150 l/min
100
30-100 l/min
20- 60 l/min
50
20
80
120
140
180
VD-008GR010
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
bronze
VD-008GR010
15
G 1/4
25
VD-010GR010
25
G 3/8
15
25
G 1/2
VD-015GR...
20
30
40
60
25
G 3/4
VD-020GR...
25
60
85
VD-025GR...
G1
100
16
145
VD-032GR...
G 1 1/4
16
VD-040GR...
G 1 1/2
150
220
G2
16
250
290
VD-050GR...
G 2 1/2
VD-065GR...
16
400
475
G3
VD-080GR...
600
720
16
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
1 - 10
1 - 10
4 - 20
1 - 10
10 - 40
4 - 20
20 - 60
10 - 40
30 - 100
20 - 60
50 - 150
30 - 100
50 - 150
100 - 200
100 - 200
180 - 330
180 - 330
300 - 600
150
150
150
150
150
156
156
156
156
156
65
65
65
80
80
98
113
137
160
148
29
29
29
32
41
52
59
72
85
100
12
12
14
16
18
13
14
17
26
23
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.1
1.3
2.1
2.8
4.0
4.0
7.0
5% of full scale
max. 120C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.3 l/min.
MATERIALS
housing
piston
spring
piston guide
seal
magnet
cap
26
Basic
piston / valve design
Flow Switch
Novafix VD-...GR
1.1.
VD.GR
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
032
040
050
065
080
G R
010
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
010
020
040
060
100
150
200
330
600
nominal diameter
008
VD-
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
signal lamp
temperature indicator 0-120C
protection class IP 65
material certification
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
selected hysteresis
rhodium contact
temperature control 30-95C
wetted parts in brass or stainless steel
temperature up to +150C
damping for gas control
approval Germanischer Lloyd type VR
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
27
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix VD-...GK
1.1.
VD.GK
good repeatability
dirt-resistant
exact setting of switch via scale
VD-020GK020
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless steel
G 1/2
100
VD-015GK...
20
30
G 3/4
VD-020GK...
100
60
40
G1
VD-025GK...
100
60
85
145
VD-032GK...
100
100
G 1 1/4
100
220
VD-040GK...
150
G 1 1/2
250
290
G2
VD-050GK...
100
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
1 - 10
4 - 20
10 - 40
20 - 60
30 - 100
50 - 150
4 - 20
10 - 40
10 - 60
20 - 100
50 - 150
100 - 200
H
mm
L
mm
D
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
166
166
166
180
186
194
80
80
80
95
105
120
68
68
68
78
88
102
15
16
18
24
25
27
2.8
2.6
2.5
3.7
4.8
7.0
5% of full scale
max. 120C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.3 l/min.
MATERIALS
housing
piston
spring
piston sleeve
seal
magnet
cap
28
Basic
piston / valve design
Flow Switch
Novafix VD-...GK
1.1.
VD.GK
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
015
020
025
032
040
050
G K
010
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
010
020
040
060
100
150
200
nominal
diameter
015
gas/air
oil
aggressive liquids
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
VD-
water
basic type
specification
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
DN 32 - G1 1/4
DN 40 - G1 1/2
DN 50 - G2
female thread
housing stainless steel
1 - 10 l/min
4 - 20 l/min
10 - 40 l/min
(10) 20 - 60 l/min
(20) 30 - 100 l/min
50 - 150 l/min
100 - 200 l/min
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
signal lamp
temperature indicator 0-120C
protection class IP 65
material certification
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
selected hysteresis
rhodium contact
temperature control 30-95C
wetted parts in brass or stainless steel
temperature up to +150C
damping for gas control
approval Germanischer Lloyd type VR
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
29
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix VM-...GR
1.1.
VM.GR
good repeatability
dirt-resistant
high switch capability
exact setting of switch via scale
Q (l/min)
250
50-250 l/min
200
150
30-150 l/min
100
20-100 l/min
50
10- 60 l/min
10- 40 l/min
20
80
120
140
180
VM-020GR040
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
bronze/brass
100
8
15
G 1/4
VM-008GR...
10
15
100
G 3/8
VM-010GR...
G 1/2
15
VM-015GR...
100
30
G 3/4
VM-020GR...
25
40
50
25
70
G1
VM-025GR060
16
120
G 1 1/4
VM-032GR100
16
G 1 1/2
VM-040GR150
180
16
300
G2
VM-050GR250
VM-065GR400
G 2 1/2
16
480
16
G3
VM-080GR600
720
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
1- 5
2- 6
2- 6
4 - 12
144
144
144
144
144
155
156
164
195
195
68
68
68
73
87
98
113
137
160
148
29
29
29
32
41
52
59
72
85
100
12
12
13
11
12
13
14
17
26
23
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.7
2.3
3.0
4.3
5.8
7.0
3 - 12
3 - 12
4 - 20
10 - 40
10 - 60
20 - 100
30 - 150
50 - 250
50 - 400
100 - 600
5% of full scale
max. 90C
0.25 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.6 l/min.
MATERIALS
housing
piston
spring
piston guide
seal
magnet
cap
30
Basic
piston / valve design
Flow Switch
Novafix VM-...GR
1.1.
VM.GR
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
032
040
050
065
080
G R
005
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
005
006
012
020
040
060
100
150
250
400
600
nominal diameter
008
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
VM-
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
signal lamp
temperature indicator 0-120C
protection class IP 65
material certification
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
gold-plated micro switch
temperature up to 150C
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
31
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix VM-...GK
1.1.
VM.GK
good repeatability
dirt-resistant
high switch capability
exact setting of switch via scale
VM-015GK020
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless steel
VM-015GK...
100
15
30
G 1/2
100
VM-020GK...
G 3/4
40
50
VM-025GK060
100
G1
70
G 1 1/4
VM-032GK100
100
120
VM-040GK150
180
G 1 1/2
100
G2
VM-050GK250
300
100
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
L
mm
D
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
2- 6
4 - 12
139
139
139
141
152
154
80
80
80
95
105
120
68
68
68
78
88
102
15
16
18
24
25
27
2.8
2.6
2.5
3.5
4.5
6.7
4 - 20
10 - 40
10 - 60
20 - 100
30 - 150
50 - 250
5% of full scale
max. 90C
0.25 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.6 l/min.
MATERIALS
housing
piston
spring
piston sleeve
seal
magnet
cap
32
Basic
piston / valve design
Flow Switch
Novafix VM-...GK
1.1.
VM.GK
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
015
020
025
032
040
050
G K
006
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
006
012
020
040
060
100
150
250
nominal diameter
015
gas/air
oil
aggressive liquids
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
VM-
water
basic type
specification
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
DN 32 - G1 1/4
DN 40 - G1 1/2
DN 50 - G2
female thread
housing stainless steel
2 - 6 l/min
4 - 12 l/min
4 - 20 l/min
10 - 40 l/min
10 - 60 l/min
20 - 100 l/min
30 - 150 l/min
50 - 250 l/min
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
signal lamp
temperature indicator 0-120C
protection class IP 65
material certification
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
gold-plated micro switch
temperature up to 150C
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
33
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix VDO-...GR
1.1.
VDO.GR
VDO-015GR010
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
adjustable range
l/min H2O
standard
bronze/brass
15
VDO-008GR010
100
G 1/4
15
VDO-010GR010
G 3/8
100
20
30
VDO-015GR...
100
G 1/2
25
40
60
G 3/4
VDO-020GR...
60
85
VDO-025GR...
25
G1
145
VDO-032GR...
100
16
G 1 1/4
220
150
VDO-040GR...
G 1 1/2
16
VDO-050GR...
250
290
16
G2
400
475
VDO-065GR...
16
G 2 1/2
16
VDO-080GR...
600
720
G3
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
4 - 20
10 - 40
20 - 60
30 - 100
30 - 100
100 - 200
180 - 330
H
mm
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
183
183
183
184
188
190
195
203
224
224
68
68
68
73
87
98
113
137
160
148
29
29
29
32
41
52
59
72
85
100
12
12
13
11
12
13
14
17
26
23
1.3
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.7
2.2
2.9
4.2
5.8
7.8
programme
option
4 - 20
10 - 40
20 - 60
30 - 100
50 - 150
100 - 200
180 - 330
400 - 600
5% of full scale
max. 120C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.5 l/min.
scale increments
MATERIALS
housing
piston
spring
piston guide
seal
magnet
cap
tube
34
Basic
piston / valve design
Flow Switch
Novafix VDO-...GR
1.1.
VDO.GR
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
032
040
050
065
080
G R
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
010
010
020
040
060
100
150
200
330
600
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
nominal diameter
008
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
VDO-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
35
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix MXR-...GR
1.1.
MXR.GR
MXR-025GR100
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
bronze
MXR-008GR...
100
6
G 1/4
MXR-010GR...
100
10
G 3/8
MXR-015GR...
100
20
G 1/2
25
40
G 3/4
MXR-020GR...
G1
MXR-025GR...
25
60
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
L
mm
SW
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
1.5 - 6
2.5 - 10
5 - 20
10 - 40
20 - 100
194
194
194
194
198
68
68
68
73
87
29
29
29
32
41
12
12
13
11
12
1.1
1.1
1.1
1.2
1.4
bar
100%
80%
60%
40%
0
50
100
150
200 C
Compressive load
MATERIALS
housing
piston
spring
piston guide
seal
36
Basic
piston / valve design
Flow Switch
Novafix MXR-...GR
1.1.
MXR.GR
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switsch
wiring 0.212 n.o.
250 V AC 1A 50VA
cable 1.5 m
brow n blue
protection class IP 65
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
G R
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
006
006
010
020
040
100
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
nominal
diameter
MXR-
008
adjustable
range
H2O
horizontal
MXR-
basic type
specification
flow switch
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
housing Rg5/Rg6
1.5 - 6 l/min
2.5 - 10 l/min
5 - 20 l/min
10 - 40 l/min
20 - 100 l/min
housing stainless steel
special cable length
SPECIAL APPLICATIONS
MXO
indicate 20-100%
option switch head
MXM
micro switch 230V 6A
indicate 20-100%
All technical changes reserved
ZBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
37
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Thermoflux TX-...FT
1.1.
TX.FT
control an indicating
media temperature 350C
good repeatability
dirt-resistant
high switch capability
DIN flange housing
TX-015FT020K
TECHNICAL DATA
PN
bar
DN Type
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
adjustable range
l/min H2O
cast steel
40
20
15 TX-015FT...
28
30
40
55
20 TX-020FT...
4 - 20
40
80
10 - 40
25 TX-025FT...
60
40
32 TX-032FT...
100
20 - 60
135
40
30 - 100
150
40
270
40 TX-040FT...
50 - 200
40
340
270
50 TX-050FT...
100 - 250
40
400
65 TX-065FT...
40
600
150 - 300
80 TX-080FT...
950
40
200 - 400
100 TX-100FT...
2000
40
600 - 750
150 TX-150FT...
40
4000
850 - 1050
200 TX-200FT....
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
Tolerance
Media temperature
Average pressure loss
Hysteresis
4 - 20
10 - 40
20 - 60
30 - 100
50 - 200
100 - 250
150 - 300
300 - 450
350 - 500
700 - 950
1050 - 1250
H
mm
L
mm
D
mm
k
mm
d
mm
weight
kg
370
370
380
380
390
390
410
430
450
510
580
130
150
160
180
200
230
290
310
350
480
600
95
105
115
140
150
165
185
200
235
300
375
65
75
85
100
110
125
145
160
190
250
320
4x14
4x14
4x14
4x18
4x18
4x18
8x18
8x18
8x22
8x26
12x30
6.0
6.5
8.5
10.5
13.0
15.5
25.5
31.0
38.0
87.0
154.0
5% of full scale
max. 350C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.3 l/min.
bar
40
30
20
10
0
100
0
200
Compressive load
300
400 C
MATERIALS
housing
body
piston
spring
piston sleeve
seal
magnet
tube
38
Basic
piston / valve design
Flow Switch
Thermoflux TX-...FT
1.1.
TX.FT
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
015
020
025
032
040
050
065
080
100
150
200
008
008
020
040
060
100
200
250
300
400
450
500
750
950
1050
1250
B
K
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
nominal diameter
015
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
TX-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
39
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow MP-...GR
1.2.
MP.GR
MP-015GR020
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
indicating range
l/min H2O
bronze/brass
Standard
100
6
10
1.5 - 6
MP-008GR...
G 1/4
MP-010GR...
2.5 - 10
100
G 3/8
10
MP-015GR...
100
G 1/2
20
5 - 20
G 3/4
MP-020GR...
25
40
10 - 40
MP-025GR...
G1
25
60
10 - 40
MP-032GR...
G 1 1/4
16
100
20 - 100
MP-040GR150
G 1 1/2
150
16
30 - 150
G2
MP-050GR...
250
16
50 - 250
G 2 1/2
MP-065GR...
16
400
80 - 400
600
120 - 600
G3
MP-080GR...
16
Indicating range is calibrated for vertical upward increasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
Programme option
2.5 - 10
1.5 - 6
2.5 - 10
1.5 - 6
2.5 - 10
5 - 20
2.5 - 10
5 - 20
12 - 60
30 - 150
50 - 250
80 - 400
H
mm
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
130
130
130
133
136
150
154
184
200
200
68
68
68
73
87
98
113
137
160
148
29
29
29
32
41
52
59
72
85
100
12
12
13
11
12
13
14
17
26
23
1.1
1.1
1.1
1.2
1.4
2.0
2.6
4.2
5.6
8.3
MATERIALS
housing
piston
spring
piston guide
tube
40
indication scale
1 = 100% = 20l/min
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow MP-...GR
1.2.
MP.GR
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
032
040
050
065
080
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
G R
006
006
010
020
040
060
100
150
250
400
600
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z/R
Z/R
Z/R
Z
R
Z/R
Z/R
Z/R
Z/R
Z
R
0
nominal diameter
008
indicating range
H2O horizontal
MP-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
41
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Novatron TZ1-...GR
1.3.
TZ1.GR
local metering
good repeatability
dirt-resistant
low pressure loss
easy adjustment by indicating pointer
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
TZ1-025GR060
PN
bar
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
bronze/brass
8
12
100
G 1/4
TZ1-008GR...
12
100
10
G 3/8
TZ1-010GR...
100
TZ1-015GR...
20
G 1/2
TZ1-020GR...
25
40
G 3/4
TZ1-025GR060
25
60
G1
G 1 1/4
TZ1-032GR100
16
100
TZ1-040GR150
G 1 1/2
16
150
250
G2
16
TZ1-050GR250
16
400
G 2 1/2
TZ1-065GR400
G3
TZ1-080GR600
16
600
Metering range is indicated for horizontally increasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
metering range
l/min H2O
2- 6
2- 6
2- 6
4 - 20
3 - 12
3 - 12
4 - 20
10 - 40
10 - 60
10 - 100
10 - 150
20 - 250
30 - 400
30 - 600
H
mm
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
212
212
212
212
216
226
228
236
268
268
68
68
68
73
87
98
113
137
160
148
29
29
29
32
41
52
59
72
85
100
12
12
13
11
12
13
14
17
26
23
1.6
1.6
1.6
1.7
2.0
2.6
3.1
6.4
7.5
8.7
3% of full scale
max. 90C
0.25bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
housing
piston/disc
spring
piston sleeve
magnet
seal
42
Basic
piston / valve design
Flowmeter
Novatron TZ1-...GR
1.3.
TZ1.GR
ELECTRICAL DATA
R BASIC Programme option
Z BASIC Standard
No electrical components.
INSTALLATION POSITIONS
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
032
040
050
065
080
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
G R
006
006
012
020
040
060
100
150
250
400
600
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
0
nominal diameter
TZ1TZ1M-
008
metering range
H2O horizontal
TZ1-
Please indicate flow direction, metering substance and metering range with your order.
With viscous liquids please indicate viscosity, temperature and metering substance (metering range on request)
With gaseous media indicate pressure (relative or absolute), temperature and metering substance (metering range on request)
For additional information concerning options micro switch and front switch see data sheet 1.3.TZ1.ZE.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
43
Basic
piston / valve design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Novatron TZ1-...GK
1.3.
TZ1.GK
local metering
good repeatability
dirt-resistant
low pressure loss
easy adjustment by indicating pointer
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
TZ1-015GK006
PN
bar
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
stainles steel
20
100
TZ1-015GK...
G 1/2
TZ1-020GK...
100
40
G 3/4
TZ1-025GK060
60
G1
100
TZ1-032GK100
100
G 1 1/4
100
TZ1-040GK150
100
G 1 1/2
150
TZ1-050GK250
100
G2
250
Metering range is indicated for horizontally increasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
metering range
l/min H2O
2- 6
4 - 20
4 - 20
5 - 40
10 - 60
10 - 100
10 - 150
20 - 250
H
mm
L
mm
D
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
210
210
210
210
223
225
80
80
80
95
105
120
68
68
68
78
88
102
15
16
18
24
25
27
2.9
2.8
2.7
3.4
3.8
5.1
3% of full scale
max. 90C
0.25bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
housing
piston/disc
spring
piston sleeve
magnet
seal
44
Basic
piston / valve design
Flowmeter
Novatron TZ1-...GK
1.3.
TZ1.GK
ELECTRICAL DATA
Z BASIC Standard
No electrical components.
INSTALLATION POSITIONS
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
015
020
025
032
040
050
G K
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
006
006
020
040
060
100
150
250
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
0
nominal diam
TZ1TZ1M-
015
gas/air
oil
aggressive liquids
metering range
H2O horizontal
TZ1-
water
basic type
specification
Flowmeter
Flowmeter with integrated micro switch
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
DN 32 - G1 1/4
DN 40 - G1 1/2
DN 50 - G2
female thread
housing stainless steel
2 - 6 l/min
4 - 20 l/min
5 - 40 l/min
10 - 60 l/min
10 - 100 l/min
10 - 150 l/min
20 - 250 l/min
front switch unit with 10-kOhm-potentiometer
diode
special range
metering range for oil or gas
front switch unit 2pol, n.o. or n.c.
Please indicate flow direction, metering substance and metering range with your order.
With viscous liquids please indicate viscosity, temperature and metering substance (metering range on request)
With gaseous media indicate pressure (relative or absolute), temperature and metering substance (metering range on request)
For additional information concerning options micro switch and front switch see data sheet 1.3.TZ1.ZE.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
45
Basic
Additional features
for Novatron TZ1-
1.3.
TZ1.ZE
OPTION
R TZ1M- integrated micro switch
wiring 0.342 change over
250 V AC 5 A
plug DIN 43650-A
protection class IP 65
1.switch
2.switch
1.switch
2.switch
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
46
Special applications
Flow control instruments PD-...TH, PD-...MH, PD-...FH
PVC for aggressive media, non-compatible for metal materials
Mechanical flow control instrument for liquid or gaseous
media, with non-contact triggering of an adjustable reed contact. Sturdy construction made
of PVC.
DN 15-80
l Reed switch
l Ranges from 2-500 l/min
l Pressure rating PN 10
l Max. temperature 60 C
l PVC material
l Flange DN 15-300
[stainless steel DN 15-150]
l Reed switch
l Ranges from 2-1600 l/min
l Pressure rating PN 16-40
l Max. temperature 120 C
l Red bronze, cast iron,
cast steel or stainless steel
material
l Flange DN 15-200
l Micro-switch
l Ranges from 5-4000 l/min
l Pressure rating PN 16
l Max. temperature 90 C
l Cast iron material
47
Basic
Special applications
Flow control instruments VI-...GR
Without magnets for media with ferrite soiling
l Flange DN 65-200
l Dial unit
l Ranges from 50-4000 l/min
l Pressure rating PN 16
l Max. temperature 90 C
l Cast iron material
l Option: cast steel
stainless steel
48
Why to use a
Basic
maintenance advantage
accurate setting
optional installation
l Valve housing
Where to use a
Basic
Market segments
l Power plant
l Machine tools
l Welding technology
l Gears
l Heat transfer
installation
l Pumps
Application
l Providing reliable flow situation in cooling system
l Controlling the emulsion supply for high performance tools
l Creating alarm in case of failures or drop of oil feed into gear
boxes
l Running dry protection of pumps
50
Applications
l
l
l
l
l
Contents
Advantages
l
l
l
l
l
l
Dirt resistant
High switching capacity
Numerous materials
High pressure resistance
Nominal diameters DN 3 to DN 50
Viscosity compensation possible
System description
Device system
52
52
53
54
Device descriptions
55
Technical data
Concept
Nominal diameter
Connection
PN
Max. temperature
Signal
Adjustable
Materials
Installation position
Metering materials
l Switching
l Indicating
l Metering
51
Basic
System description
Device system
The piston system inline design is used for monitoring and indicating
liquid and gaseous metering materials. A magnet-equipped and springsupported piston moves in a linear-shaped body and is moved in the
direction of flow by the flowing medium, whereby the path of the piston
is directly proportional to the flow rate. Since the piston is springsupported, the devices can be installed in any position and reset safely
when the volume flow diminishes.
no flow
flow
side display O1
l
l
l
l
Easy to mount
Touchless needle coupling
Good readability
Mounting on the front or side
front display Z1
52
Water
MR
MR1K
HD1K
4
8
10
20
4
10
30
40
5
10
30
40
Example with
viscosity compensation:
Viscosity mm/s
30
3
6
8
18
1.9
4.7
24.6
34.8
2.1
4.7
24.6
34.8
60
1.4
3
5
13
1.3
3.9
24
33.6
1.6
3.9
24
33.6
115
1
2
4
13
0.8
2.6
23.3
32.6
0.8
2.6
23.3
32.6
220
2
10
22.7
31.8
22.7
31.8
For this reason options have been developed which allow viscosity
stability. These devices work in a certain viscosity range without
exceeding the permitted tolerances. This is of particular interest for
oils with different temperature ranges.
Path
Viscosity
16 mm
1 mm/s
16 mm 115 mm/s
Flow rate
5,0 l/min
0,8 l/min
Example with
viscosity compensation:
Path
Viscosity
16 mm
1 mm/s
16 mm 115 mm/s
Quantity
5,0 l/min
4,9 l/min
In the case of air and gases the device mechanisms must be equipped
with additional absorption. The metering and monitoring ranges are
extremely dependent on operating conditions such as pressure, density
and temperature. The functional ratio in relation to water is approx.
1:35, i.e. 1 l/min water corresponds to approx. 35 Nl/min air, whereby temperature, density and operating pressure play a special role here.
We will be happy to give you special advice in these cases.
53
Basic
NJVK
The Honsberg magnetic displays [NJ, NJV] are mainly used in industry
for non-transparent metering materials and/or higher pressures.
54
standard application
special application
3
3
3
10
80
56
58
filter
8 - 25
l
l
m
m
m
m
200 120
200 120
HD2K
8 - 25
l
l
m
m
m
m
200 120
200 120
HM1K
8 - 25
l
l
m
m
m
m
200
200
32 - 50
l
l
m
m
m
m
200 120
200 120
MF
3
7
l
l
MR
8 - 25
l
l
m
m
m
m
200 120
200 120
l
l
3
3
3
3
MR1K
8 - 25
l
l
m
m
m
m
200 120
200 120
l
l
3
3
3
3
RVM
l
l
300 100
300 100
l
l
3
3
NH1
15
NJ
8 - 25
m
m
l
l
100 100
100 100
NJV
8 - 25
100 100
MH
8 - 25
10
65
6
6
10
70
70
80
80
65
l
l
3
3
3
3
l
l
3
3
l
l
3
3
3
3
l
l
3
3
3
3
79
85
88
82
l
l
16
16
100
100
l
l
3
3
3
3
VO
15 - 25
m
m
l
l
16
16
100
100
l
l
3
3
3
3
NO
8 - 25
m
m
l
l
50
50
90
90
l
l
3
3
3
3
AR
10
150
80
MI
8 - 25
l
l
16
16
60
60
l
l
3
3
3
3
OT
15 - 20
10
100
special option
77
3
3
m
m
m standard option
75
3
3
70
81
67
73
74
VF
l
l
64
l
l
l
59
61
page
3
3
3
miscellaneous
l
l
l
aggressive
gas/air
90
90
90
on site metering
10
100
100
output signal
l
l
l
indication
HD1K
HR1MV
l standard
oil
15
water
FX
max. temperature C
FW3
8 - 25
8 - 25
8
control
FW1
connection
type
nominal diameter
90
92
94
96
96
3
valve
96
55
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix FW1-...GP/GM
1.1.
FW1.
TECHNICAL DATA
G
PN
bar
Type
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
adjustable range
l/min H2O
L
mm
H
mm
B
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
1- 6
1- 11
1- 11
1- 6
1- 6
1- 6
1- 11
1- 11
85
100
100
89
89
85
100
100
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
36
40
25
25
25
36
40
27
-
12
18
18
18
18
12
18
18
0.04
0.13
0.17
0.33
0.31
0.28
0.72
0.83
brass
POM
G 1/2
FW1-015GP006
10
20
10
G 3/4
FW1-020GP011
30
G1
FW1-025GP011
10
30
FW1-008GM006
G 1/4
100
8
100
10
FW1-010GM006
G 3/8
FW1-015GM006
100
20
G 1/2
FW1-020GM011
100
30
G 3/4
30
G1
FW1-025GM011
100
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
FW1-008GM - FW1-010GM
FW1-015GP
FW1-020G. - FW1-025G.
MATERIALS
housing
piston
spring
magnet
seals
switch head
FW1-015GM
FW1-...GP
FW1-...GM
56
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix FW1-...GP/GM
1.1.
FW1.
ELECTRICAL DATA
free
1
brown
MOUNTING POSITION
2
white
3
blue
4
black
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
FW1-
008
008
010
015
020
025
G P
P
M
Special option
VARIO
006
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
0
006
011
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 8 - G1/4 (only brass design)
nominal diameter DN 10 - G3/8 (only brass design)
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 20- G3/4
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
female thread
plastic POM
brass
adjustable range 1- 6 l/min horizontal H2O
adjustable range 1- 11 l/min horizontal H2O
switch values for oil or gas
cable 3 m
PN 500 (DN 15)
ACCESSORY
Locking plug M12x1
PU-
K
KB04
PU-
02
02
05
10
S G
G
W
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
basic type
specification
ready-made cable
self makable cable 4-pole
material PUR
length 2 m
length 5 m
length 10 m
moulded-on plug
straight plug
angled plug 90
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
57
Basic
flow switch
Novafix FW3-...GM
1.1.
FW3.
FW3-008GM
TECHNICAL DATA
M
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min
brass
G1/4
FW3-008GM
100
Switch value is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
weight
kg
0.4 - 2.5
0.25
MATERIALS
housing
piston
piston stop
spring
magnet
switch head
MOUNTING POSITION
Installation position may
influence switch value.
ELECTRICAL DATA
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
gas/air
2
white
3
blue
4
black
NOMENCLATURE
FW3-
008
G M
G
Programme option
[
[
S
Beispiel
Beschreibung
female thread G 1/4
brass design
cable 3 m
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
58
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvafix FX-015AP
1.1.
FX.
FX-015AP
TECHNICAL DATA
G
PN
bar
(20C)
Type
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
weight
kg
12
12
0.4 - 5
2.0 - 12
0.14
0.15
G1/2A
POM
FX-015AP
10
FXF-015AP
10
Switch value is indicated for upward decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
filter
FX-015AP
FXF-015AP
MATERIALS
body
piston
snap ring
spring
magnet
seals
filter
FX-015AP
POM glass-fibre
brass Ms58
CuSn8F70
bariumferrite
NBR
nylon/POM
FXF-015AP
POM glass-fibre
brass Ms58
CuSn8F70
stainless steel 1.4310
bariumferrite
NBR
nylon/POM
59
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Switch
Fluvafix FX-015AP
1.1.
FX.
ELECTRICAL DATA
brown
blue
MOUNTING POSITION
FX
METERING SUBSTANCES
FXF
water
gas/air
Position may influence switch
value.
NOMENCLATURE
FXFXFXF-
015
015
Programme option
BASIC
A P
[
[
[
[
[
S
basic type
specification
Flow Switch
Flow Switch with additional spring support
nominal diameter DN 15
male thread
plastic design
integrated flow regulator
OPTIONS
S Flow Switch with integrating flow regulator
limiter flow rates
tolerance
temperature
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
60
Basic
piston / inline design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix HD1K-...GM/GK
1.1.
HD1K.
good repeatabilty
dirt-resistance
high switch capability
hermetic separation of mechanical
and electrical component
exact setting of switch via scale + gear
HD1K-020GM040
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless
steel
brass
200
10
HD1K-008GM005
G 1/4
200
20
HD1K-010GM...
G 3/8
40
HD1K-015GM...
200
G 1/2
HD1K-020GM...
60
200
G 3/4
200
80
G1
HD1K-025GM...
200
10
G 1/4
HD1K-008GK005
200
20
HD1K-010GK...
G 3/8
G 1/2
40
HD1K-015GK...
200
HD1K-020GK...
200
60
G 3/4
200
80
HD1K-025GK...
G1
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
0.5 - 5
0.5 - 5
1 - 10
3 - 30
4 - 40
0.5 - 5
0.5 - 5
1 - 10
3 - 30
4 - 40
1
2
4
6
- 10
- 20
- 40
- 60
1
2
4
6
- 10
- 20
- 40
- 60
3 - 30
3 - 30
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
40
40
40
40
40
41
41
41
41
41
15
15
15
18
18
15
15
15
18
18
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.1
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.1
5% of full scale
max. 120C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.7 l/min.
MATERIALS
body
HD1K-...GM
piston
spring
magnet
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4310
bariumferrite
seals
switch head
NBR
polycarbonate
HD1K-...GK
61
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix HD1K-...GM/GK
wiring 0.342
SBASIC
Programmeoptions
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
G M
M
K
005
[
S
[
S
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
005
010
020
030
040
060
Programme option
BASIC
diode red/green
wiring 0.347
green
water
gas/air
oil
basic type
specification
Flow Switch
Flow Indicator
without metering unit
with lateral flow metering unit
with front flow metering unit
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
brass
stainless steel
0.5 - 5 l/min
1 - 10 l/min
2 - 20 l/min
3 - 30 l/min
4 - 40 l/min
6 - 60 l/min
S
S
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
62
red
Special option
VARIO
nominal
diameter
OZ-
008
diode red
wiring 0.208
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
HD1K
H1
HD1K.
METERING SUBSTANCES
HD1K
1.1.
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Switch
Novafix HD1K-...GM/GK
1.1.
HD1K.
0,5 - 6
1 - 12
2 - 23
4 - 34
5 - 45
5 - 65
0,5 - 6
1 - 12
2 - 22
3 - 34
4 - 45
5 - 65
Flex-K-HD1K
switch- or frequency output
0..10V or 4..20mA
PNP, NPN
omni-HD1K
2xNPN and PNP switch point
4(0)..20mA ouput
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED, program ring
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
63
Basic
piston / inline design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Mechanical Flow Switch for liquids media, with springsupported piston and magnetic triggering of a reed switch.
Rugged construction in brass or stainless steel with
additional viscosity compensation.
Flow Switch
Novafix HD2K-...GM/GK
1.1.
HD2K.
HD2K-020GM040
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
stainless steel
brass
0.5 - 8
G 1/4
200
HD2K-008GM
1.5 - 15
0.5 - 8
G 3/8
200
HD2K-010GM...
1.5 - 15
2.5 - 25
0.5 - 8
G 1/2
HD2K-015GM...
200
1.5 - 15
0.5 - 8
2.5 - 25
6 - 40
G 3/4
200
HD2K-020GM...
0.5 - 8
1.5 - 15
6 - 40
2.5 - 25
200
G1
HD2K-025GM...
0.5 - 8
G 1/4
HD2K-008GK
200
0.5 - 8
1.5 - 15
G 3/8
HD2K-010GK...
200
0.5 - 8
1.5 - 15
2.5 - 25
G 1/2
200
HD2K-015GK...
2.5 - 25
6 - 40
0.5 - 8
1.5 - 15
G 3/4
200
HD2K-020GK...
0.5 - 8
1.5 - 15
2.5 - 25
6 - 40
G1
200
HD2K-025GK...
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow. Calibration with oil ISO VG100.
adjustable
range
0,5 - 8
1,5 - 15
2,5 - 25
6 - 40
12 - 60
Qmax.
viscosity stability
12
22
35
60
80
tolerance
media temperature
hysteresis
12 - 60
12 - 60
SW
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
40
40
40
40
40
41
41
41
41
41
15
15
15
18
18
15
15
15
18
18
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.1
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.1
5% of full scale
max. 120C
depending on switch value
value minimum 0.5 l/min.
MATERIALS
HD2K-...GM
body
piston
spring
magnet
seal
switch head
NBR
PC
HD2K-...GK
64
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix HD2K-...GM/GK
wiring 0.342
SBASIC
Programmeoptions
MOUNTING POSITION
1.1.
HD2K.
diode red
wiring 0.208
diode red/green
wiring 0.347
green
red
METERING SUBSTANCES
oil
water
NOMENCLATURE
OZ-
008
008
010
015
020
025
G M
M
K
005
[
S
[
S
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
008
015
025
040
060
Programme option
BASIC
basic type
specification
Flow Switch
Flow Indicator
without metering unit
with lateral flow metering unit
with front flow metering unit
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
brass
stainless steel
0.5 - 8 l/min
1.5 - 15 l/min
2.5 - 25 l/min
6 - 40 l/min
12 - 60 l/min
S
S
Special option
VARIO
nominal
diameter
HD2K
H2
adjustable
range l
horizontal
HD2K
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
65
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Switch
Novafix HD2K-...GM/GK
1.1.
HD2K.
- 8
- 15
- 25
- 40
- 60
0.5
2
2.5
7.5
15
- 10
- 20
- 30
- 50
- 70
- 8
- 15
- 25
- 40
- 60
0.5
2
2.5
7.5
15
- 10
- 20
- 30
- 50
- 70
Flex-K-HD2K
switch- or frequency output
0..10V or 4..20mA
PNP, NPN
omni-HD2K
2xNPN and PNP switch point
4(0)..20mA ouput
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED, program ring
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
66
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix HM1K-...GM/GK
1.1.
HM1K.
micro switch
good repeatabilty
dirt-resistance
high switch capability
hermetic separation of mechanical
and electrical component
exact setting of switch via scale + gear
HM1K-020GM036
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless
steel
brass
200
10
G 1/4
HM1K-008GM004
200
20
G 3/8
HM1K-010GM...
40
HM1K-015GM...
200
G 1/2
60
HM1K-020GM...
200
G 3/4
200
80
HM1K-025GM...
G1
200
10
G 1/4
HM1K-008GK004
200
G 3/8
HM1K-010GK...
20
G 1/2
200
40
HM1K-015GK...
HM1K-020GK...
200
60
G 3/4
200
HM1K-025GK...
80
G1
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
0.5 - 4
0.5 - 4
1 - 8
3 - 26
4 - 36
0.5 - 4
0.5 - 4
1 - 8
3 - 26
4 - 36
1
2
4
6
- 8
- 16
- 36
- 55
1
2
4
6
- 8
- 16
- 36
- 55
3 - 26
3 - 26
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
40
40
40
40
40
41
41
41
41
41
15
15
15
18
18
15
15
15
18
18
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.1
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.1
5% of full scale
max. 70C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 1 l/min.
MATERIALS
body
HM1K-...GM
piston
spring
magnet
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4310
bariumferrite
seals
switch head
NBR
polycarbonate
HM1K-...GK
67
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix HM1K-...GM/GK
wiring 0.342
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
G M
Programme option
BASIC
M
K
005
004
008
016
026
036
055
[
S
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
0
Special option
VARIO
nominal
diameter
008
010
015
020
025
diode red
wiring 0.208
diode red/green
wiring 0.347
green
water
gas/air
oil
basic type
specification
Flow Switch
Description see next
Flow Switch with lateral flow metering unit
page.
Flow Switch with front flow metering unit
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
brass
stainless steel
0.5 - 4 l/min
1 - 8 l/min
2 - 16 l/min
3 - 26 l/min
4 - 36 l/min
6 - 55 l/min
wiring 0.342
wiring 0.208 - diode red integrated in plug DIN 43650-A
wiring 0.347 - diode red/green integrated in plug DIN 43650-A
incremented scale
switch head metal
contact for locking plug M 12x1, 4-pole
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
special setting
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
68
red
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
HM1KHM1KOHM1KZ-
HM1K.
METERING SUBSTANCES
HM1K- 008
SBASIC
Programmeoptions
1.1.
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Switch
Novafix HM1K-...GM/GK
1.1.
HM1K.
0,5 - 6
1 - 12
2 - 23
4 - 34
5 - 45
5 - 65
0.5 - 4
1 - 8
2 - 16
3 - 26
4 - 36
6 - 55
Flex-K-HD1K
switch- or frequency output
0..10V or 4..20mA
PNP, NPN
omni-HD1K
2xNPN and PNP switch point
4(0)..20mA ouput
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED, program ring
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
69
Basic
piston / inline design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix HR1MV-...GM/GK
1.1.
HR1MV.
HR1MV-032GM060
TECHNICAL DATA
PN
bar
Type
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
adjustable range
l/min oil 1-200mm/s
stainless
steel
brass
10 - 40
20 - 60
100
200
HR1MV-032GM...
G 1 1/4
20 - 60
30 - 100
150
200
HR1MV-040GM...
G 1 1/2
30 - 100
50 - 150
230
200
HR1MV-050GM...
G2
10 - 40
20 - 60
200
100
G 1 1/4
HR1MV-032GK...
20 - 60
30 - 100
200
150
G 1 1/2
HR1MV-040GK...
30 - 100
50 - 150
G2
200
230
HR1MV-050GK...
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow. Calibration with oil ISO VG64 - 80mm/s.
viscosity stability
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
L
mm
X
mm
AF
mm
weight
kg
165
165
150
165
165
150
29
29
26
29
29
26
70
70
70
70
-
6.0
5.7
5.2
6.0
5.7
5.2
3%
5% of full scale
max. 120C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
value minimum 2 l/min.
50
100
150
200 mm/s
MATERIALS
body
metering unit
spring
magnet
seal
HR1MV-...GM
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
1.4310
hardferrite
NBR (DN32-40 only)
HR1MV-...GK
70
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix HR1MV-...GM/GK
1.1.
HR1MV.
ELECTRICAL DATA
blue
green/
yellow
black
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
032
040
050
065
080
M
K
040
060
100
150
adjusable
range
OZ-
[
S
[
S
S
[
[
[
S
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
nominal
diameter
032 G M 040
HR1MV
HR1MV
H1V
S
S
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
71
Basic
piston / inline design
S HR1MVO-
Flow Switch
Novafix HR1MV-...GM/GK
1.1.
HR1MV.
10 - 45
20 - 65
30 - 110
50 - 160
S HR1MVZ-
10 - 45
20 - 65
30 - 110
50 - 160
nominal diameter DN 65
Flex-K-HR1MV
switch- or frequency output
0..10V or 4..20mA
PNP, NPN
omni-HR1MV
2xNPN and PNP switch point
4(0)..20mA ouput
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED, program ring
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
72
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvamat MF-003GM
1.1.
MF.003
compact dimensions
control of small flow rates
MF-003GM
TECHNICAL DATA
M
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recomended
l/min
brass
M5
MF-003GM
6
Switch value is indicated for horizontally descreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
100
weight
kg
1 - 100
0.06
MATERIALS
body
piston
spring
magnet
seal
brass Ms58
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4310
bariumferrite
NBR
MOUNTING POSITION
Installation position may
influence switch value.
ELECTRICAL DATA
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
MF-
003
G M
G
gas/air
[
[
basic type
specification
female thread M5
brass
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
73
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvamat MF-007GM
1.1.
MF.007
TECHNICAL DATA
M
MF-007GM
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recomended
l/min H2O
weight
kg
0.05 - 1.0
0.18
brass
M10x1
MF-007GM
6
The switch value is valid for flow to up and decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
MATERIALS
body
piston
spring
seal
brass Ms58
brass Ms58
bariumferrite
NBR
MOUNTING POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
MF-
007
G M
G
water
[
[
basic type
specification
female thread M10x1
brass
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
74
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvamat MR-...GM/GK
1.1.
MR.
compact dimension
good repeatabilty
dirt-resistance
high switch capability
hermetic separation of mechanical
and electrical component
MR-020GM020
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
stainless
steel
brass
15
200
MR-008GM...
G 1/4
20
200
MR-010GM...
G 3/8
MR-015GM...
200
40
G 1/2
MR-020GM...
200
60
G 3/4
200
MR-025GM...
80
G1
200
15
MR-008GK...
G 1/4
MR-010GK...
G 3/8
200
20
G 1/2
MR-015GK...
40
200
G 3/4
MR-020GK...
200
60
G1
200
80
MR-025GK...
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
0.4 - 4
0.4 - 4
0.4 - 4
1 - 10
5 - 20
0.4 - 4
0.4 - 4
0.4 - 4
1 - 10
5 - 20
1 - 10
1 - 10
1 - 10
5 - 20
10 - 40
1 - 10
1 - 10
1 - 10
5 - 20
10 - 40
5 - 20
5 - 20
10 - 40
20 - 60
5 - 20
5 - 20
10 - 40
20 - 60
L
mm
H
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
109
109
109
109
135
109
109
109
109
135
56
56
56
56
56
56
56
56
56
56
36
36
36
36
40
36
36
36
36
41
12
12
12
12
18
12
12
12
12
18
0.85
0.85
0.80
0.80
1.50
0.85
0.85
0.80
0.80
1.50
5% of full scale
max. 120C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.5 l/min.
MATERIALS
body
MR-...GM
spring
magnet
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4305;
1.4301
stainless steel 1.4310
bariumferrite
seal
switch head
NBR
PA
piston
MR-...GK
75
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Switch
Fluvamat MR-...GM/GK
1.1.
MR.
ELECTRICAL DATA
blue
black
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
G M
Special option
VARIO
M
K
004
004
010
020
040
060
[
3
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
0
nominal
diameter
MRMRO-
008
gas/air
oil
adjustable
range H2O
horizontal
MR-
water
basic type
specification
Flow Switch
Flow Switch with lateral flow metering unit ( DN 8-20 - PN90 )
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
brass
stainless steel
0.4 - 4 l/min
1 - 10 l/min
5 - 20 l/min
10 - 40 l/min
20 - 60 l/min
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
special ranges
selected hysteresis / vibration-proof
rhodium contact
high pressure PN 400 bar
plug DIN 43650-A
connection for locking plug M12x1 , 4-pole
OPTION
3 MRO- Flow Switch with lateral flow metering
adjustable range metering range
l/min H2O
l/min H2O
0.4 - 4
1 - 10
5 - 20
10 - 40
20 - 60
0.5 - 5
1 - 12
5 - 25
5 - 40
20 - 60
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
76
Basic
piston / inline design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Novafix MR1K-...GM/GK
1.1.
MR1K.
compact dimension
good repeatabilty
dirt-resistance
high switch capability
hermetic separation of mechanical
and electrical component
MR1K-010GM004
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless
steel
brass
200
MR1K-008GM004
10
G 1/4
MR1K-010GM...
200
20
G 3/8
MR1K-015GM...
200
40
G 1/2
200
MR1K-020GM...
60
G 3/4
MR1K-025GM...
200
80
G1
10
G 1/4
MR1K-008GK004
200
MR1K-010GK...
200
20
G 3/8
200
40
G 1/2
MR1K-015GK...
MR1K-020GK...
200
60
G 3/4
200
MR1K-025GK...
80
G1
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
0.4 - 4
0.4 - 4
1 - 10
3 - 30
4 - 40
0.4 - 4
0.4 - 4
1 - 10
3 - 30
4 - 40
1 - 10
2 - 20
4 - 40
6 - 60
1 - 10
2 - 20
4 - 40
6 - 60
3 - 30
3 - 30
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
40
40
40
40
40
41
41
41
41
41
15
15
15
18
18
15
15
15
18
18
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.1
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.2
1.1
5% of full scale
max. 120C
0.5 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.5 l/min.
MATERIALS
body
MR1K-...GM
piston
spring
magnet
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4310
bariumferrite
seal
switch head
NBR
polycarbonate
MR1K-...GK
77
Basic
Flow Switch
Novafix MR1K-...GM/GK
MOUNTING POSITION
SBASIC
Programmeoptions
wiring 0.342
NOMENCLATURE
G M
M
K
004
004
010
020
030
040
060
Programme option
BASIC
[
[
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
S
0
Special option
VARIO
nominal
diameter
008
010
015
020
025
diode red
wiring 0.208
diode red/green
wiring 0.347
green
red
water
gas/air
oil
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
MR1KMR1KJMR1KO-
008
MR1K.
METERING SUBSTANCES
MR1K-
1.1.
basic type
specification
Flow Switch
Flow Switch with magnetic indication
Flow Switch with lateral flow metering unit
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
brass
stainless steel
0.4 - 4 l/min
1 - 10 l/min
2 - 20 l/min
3 - 30 l/min
4 - 40 l/min
6 - 60 l/min
connection by local electronic (e.g. omni-MR1K)
wiring 0.342
wiring 0.208 - diode red integrated in plug DIN 43650-A
wiring 0.347 - diode red/green integrated in plug DIN 43650-A
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
special ranges / selected hysteresis / vibration-proof
high pressure PN 500 bar
two to four independent switch heads
- Please indicate flow direction, metering substance and adjustable range with your order.
- With viscous liquids please indicate viscosity, temperature and metering substance (adjustable range on request)
- With gaseous media indicate pressure (relative or absolute), temperature and metering substance (adjustable range on request)
OPTION
S MR1KJ
S MR1KO
0.5 - 5
1 - 12
2 - 23
4 - 34
5 - 45
5 - 65
Metering range is indicated for horizontally increasing flow. Protection class IP60 8o9. Additional weight 0.1kg
All technical changes reserved
[BASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
78
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Switch
Fluvamat RVM-008GM/GK
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
1.1.
RVM.
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
brass
RVM-008GM013
300
168
RVM-008GM060
300
0.72
RVM-008GM300
300
3.6
168
G1/4
RVM-008GK013
300
RVM-008GK060
300
0.72
RVM-008GK300
300
3.6
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
stainless
steel
G1/4
Qmax. recom.
H2O
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
ml/min
l/min
l/min
ml/min
l/min
l/min
adjustable range
H2O
40 - 130
0.1 - 0.6
0.5 - 3.0
40 - 130
0.1 - 0.6
0.5 - 3.0
ml/min
l/min
l/min
ml/min
l/min
l/min
B
mm
weight
kg
17
17
17
18
18
18
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.15
0.15
0.15
MATERIALS
body
piston
spring
magnet
RVM-008GM
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4571
hardferrite
RVM-008GK
stainless steel 1.4571
stainless steel 1.4571
stainless steel 1.4571
hardferrite
79
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Switch
Fluvamat RVM-008GM/GK
MOUNTING POSITION
SBASIC
Programme
option
ELECTRICAL DATA
1.1.
RVM.
wiring 0.342
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
RVM-
008
008
G M
G
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
M
K
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 8 - G1/4
female thread
brass
stainless steel
adjustable range 40 - 130 ml/min H2O
adjustable range 0.1 - 0.6 l/min H2O
adjustable range 0.5 - 3.0 l/min H2O
wiring 0.213, change over
014
013
060
300
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
80
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow NH1-...GM
1.2.
NH1.
TECHNICAL DATA
NH1-015GM015
Type
PN
bar
(20C)
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
indicating range
l/min H2O
weight
kg
20
3 - 15
0.3
brass G1/2
10
NH1-015GM015
Indicating range is calibrated for vertical upward increasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
MATERIALS
connector
tube
piston
spring
seal
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
NOMENCLATURE
NH1NH1NH1K-
015
015
G M
G
A
015
015
[
[
[
[
S
[
[
basic type
specification
flow indicator
flow indicator with switch unit plastic
nominal diameter DN 15
female thread
male thread
connection brass
indicating range 3 - 15 l/min
OPTIONS
free
1
brown
2
white
3
blue
4
black
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
81
Basic
piston / inline design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Indicator
Novaflux NJ-...GM/GK
1.2.
NJ.
multiviscosity scale
for dark and/or contaminated liquids
good repeatabilty
dirt resistance
TECHNICAL DATA
NJ-015GM040
Type
PN
bar
stainless
steel
brass
NJ-008GM010
100
10
G 1/4
NJ-010GM...
100
20
G 3/8
NJ-015GM...
100
40
G 1/2
NJ-020GM...
G 3/4
100
60
NJ-025GM...
G1
100
80
10
100
G 1/4
NJ-008GK010
G 3/8
20
NJ-010GK...
100
100
40
G 1/2
NJ-015GK...
G 3/4
100
NJ-020GK...
60
80
G1
NJ-025GK...
100
Indicating range is calibrated for vertical upward increasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
1
2-10
4-20
10-40
20-80
indicating range
l/min H2O
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
2 - 10
4 - 20
4 - 20
4 - 20
4 - 20
10 - 40
10 - 40
10 - 40
20 - 80
4 - 20
4 - 20
4 - 20
4 - 20
10 - 40
10 - 40
10 - 40
20 - 80
mm/s
l/min
l/min
l/min
l/min
MATERIALS
body
NJ-...GM
piston
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
spring
magnet
seals
scale
NBR
acrylic (GS)
NJ-...GK
82
weight
kg
1.5
1.4
1.3
1.3
1.2
1.5
1.4
1.3
1.3
1.2
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Indicator
Novaflux NJ-...GM/GK
1.2.
NJ.
ELECTRICAL DATA
[ BASIC Standard
No electrical components
switch heads
for descriptions see following page
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
G M
G
W
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
Accessories
PLUS
M
K
010
010
020
040
080
[
S
S
S
S
0
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
0
nominal
diameter
NJNJM1NJM2NJK1NJK2NJK3-
008
gas/air
oil
indicating
range
NJ-
water
basic type
specification
Flow Indicator
Flow Indicator with switch head metal, wiring 0.333 (NJE100)
Flow Indicator with switch head metal, wiring 0.215 (NJE200)
Flow Indicator with switch head plastic, wiring 0.338 (NJE400)
Flow Indicator with switch head plastic, wiring 0.215
Flow Indicator with switch head plastic, wiring 0.347 (NJE400sp)
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
manifold block connector for 70.1.VB.
brass
stainless steel
2 - 10 l/min
4 - 20 l/min
H2O upward flow
10 - 40 l/min
20 - 80 l/min
signal lamp
special range
special scales
manifold block - data sheet 70.1.VB.
ACCESSORIES
Manifold
see datd sheet 70.1.VB.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
83
Basic
Flow Indicator
Novaflux NJ-...GM/GK
1.2.
NJ.
OPTION
S NJM1-
beige
white
yellow
grey
brown
blue
black
green/
yellow
S NJM2reed switch
wiring 0.215 (NJE200)
250 V AC 0.5 A 10 VA
cable gland Pg9 with 2.5 metre cable
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.45kg
brow n
blue
green/
yellow
S NJK1-
1(+)
3(-)
0 NJK3-
green
1(-)
red
2(+)
3(-)
4(-)
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
84
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Indicator
Novaflux NJV-...GM
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
1.2.
NJV.
NJV-015GM040
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min oil
1-200mm/s
indicating range
l/min oil 1-200mm/s
brass
2- 10
NJV-008GM010
100
10
G 1/4
2- 10
4- 20
G 3/8
NJV-010GM...
100
20
2- 10
4- 20
10- 40
G 1/2
NJV-015GM...
100
40
4- 20
10- 40
2- 10
60
G 3/4
NJV-020GM...
100
2- 10
4- 20
10- 40
NJV-025GM...
100
G1
80
Indicating range is calibrated for vertical upward increasing flow. Calibration with oil ISO VG64 - 80mm/s.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
weight
kg
10- 60
10- 60
1.5
1.4
1.3
1.3
1.2
50
100
150
200 mm/s
MATERIALS
body
metering unit
spring
magnet
seal
scale
85
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Indicator
Novaflux NJV-...GM
1.2.
NJV.
ELECTRICAL DATA
[ BASIC Standard
No electrical components
switch heads
for descriptions see following page
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
oil
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
G M
G
W
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
Accessories
PLUS
M
K
010
010
020
040
060
[
S
S
S
S
0
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
[
S
[
[
[
[
S
0
nominal
diameter
NJVNJVM1NJVM2NJVK1NJVK2NJVK3-
008
indicating
range
NJV-
ACCESSORIES
Manifold
see datd sheet 70.1.VB.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
86
Basic
Flow Indicator
Novaflux NJV-...GM
1.2.
NJV.
OPTION
S NJVM1-
beige
white
yellow
grey
brown
blue
black
green/
yellow
S NJVM2-
brow n
blue
green/
yellow
S NJVK1-
1(+)
3(-)
0 NJVK3-
green
1(-)
red
2(+)
3(-)
4(-)
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
87
Basic
piston / inline design
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Indicator
Novaflux MH-...GA
1.2.
MH.
MH-015GA002
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
(20C)
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
aluminium
G 1/4
10
8
MH-008GA
10
G 3/8
10
MH-010GA
10
G 1/2
20
MH-015GA
10
G 3/4
MH-020GA
40
10
MH-025GA
G1
60
Indicating range is calibrated for vertical upward increasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
indicating range
l/min H2O
0.2 - 2
0.2 - 2
0.6 - 6
1 - 10
2 - 20
0.6 - 6
0.6 - 6
1 - 10
2 - 20
5 - 40
0.8 - 8
1 - 10
2 - 20
5 - 40
10 - 50
L
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
100
100
100
120
120
14
14
14
18
18
0.45
0.45
0.45
0.50
0.50
MATERIALS
connector
body
tube
piston
spring
seal
aluminium
aluminium
Acryl XT
POM
stainless steel 1.4310
Viton
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
88
Basic
piston / inline design
Flow Indicator
Novaflux MH-...GA
1.2.
MH.
ELECTRICAL DATA
[ BASIC Standard
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
Indicate installation
position in your order
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
G A
programme option
BASIC
002
002
006
008
010
020
030
040
050
[
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
nominal
diameter
MHMHK-
008
gas/air
indicating
range
H2O
MH-
basic type
specification
flow indicator
flow indicator with switch unit plastic
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
housing aluminium
0.2 - 2 l/min
0.6 - 6 l/min
0.8 - 8 l/min
1 - 10 l/min
2 - 20 l/min
3 - 30 l/min
5 - 40 l/min
10 - 50 l/min
housing POM
OPTIONS
S MHK- flow indicator with switch unit plastic
reed switch - wiring 0.212 n.o.
250 V AC 0.5 A 10 VA
contact for locking plug M 12x1, 4-pole
protection class IP 65
free
1
brown
2
white
3
blue
4
black
adjustable range
indicating range
l/min H2O
l/min H2O
0.4 - 1.8
0.2 - 2
0.6 - 5.5
0.6 - 6
0.8 - 7.5
0.8 - 8
1 - 9
1 - 10
2 - 16
2 - 20
5 - 40
5 - 36
10 - 50
10 - 45
Swich range is indicated for horizontally
decreasing flow.
Additional weight 0.02kg
All technical changes reserved
[BASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
89
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow VF-008GA/GK
1.2.
VF.
VFR-008GA014
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
G1/4
Qmax. recom.
H2O
stainless
steel
brass
VF-008GA006
16
VF-008GA013
16
VF-008GA060
16
16
VF-008GA300
16
VF-008GA500
G1/4
16
VF-008GK006
VF-008GK013
16
VF-008GK060
16
VF-008GK300
16
16
VF-008GK500
Indicating range is calibrated for vertical upward increasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
60
130
0.6
3
5
60
130
0.6
3
5
ml/min
ml/min
l/min
l/min
l/min
ml/min
ml/min
l/min
l/min
l/min
indicating range
H2O
5
25
0.1
0.5
1
5
25
0.1
0.5
1
- 60
- 130
- 0.6
-3
-5
- 60
- 130
- 0.6
-3
-5
ml/min
ml/min
l/min
l/min
l/min
ml/min
ml/min
l/min
l/min
l/min
MATERIALS
housing
connectors
glass
piston
spring
magnet
seal
VF-008GA
aluminium anodized
brass Ms58
nickel plated
duran 50
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4571
hardferrite
NBR
VF-008GK
aluminium anodized
stainless steel 1.4571
duran 50
stainless steel 1.4571
dotted lines: option switch head VFRstainless steel 1.4571
hardferrite
viton
90
weight
kg
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.14
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow VF-008GA/GK
ELECTRICAL DATA
[ BASIC Standard
No electrical components
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
008
G A
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
B
1
water
gas/air
oil
A
K
006
006
013
060
300
500
[
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
0
indicating
range H2O
VFVFR-
008
VF.
METERING SUBSTANCES
VF-
1.2.
basic type
specification
Flow Indicator
Flow Indicator with switch head
nominal diameter DN 8 - G1/4
female thread
connector material brass
connector material stainless steel
5 - 60 ml/min
25 - 130 ml/min
0.1 - 0.6 l/min
0.5 - 3 l/min
1 - 5 l/min
wiring 0.342 - change over
setting / switch ranges for oil or gas
scale 0 - 100%
special scale, special ranges
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
91
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow VO-...GA/GK
1.2.
VO.
VOR-015GA0040
TECHNICAL DATA
G
PN
bar
Type
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
indicating range
H2O
D
mm
H
mm
L
mm
X
mm
AF
mm
weight
kg
32
53
114
27
0.3
50
77
158
10
41
1.0
G1/2
0.5
VO-015G.0005
10
10
1
VO-015G.0010
1.6
VO-015G.0016
10
10
VO-015G.0040
4
10
8
VO-015G.0080
10
22
VO-015G.0220
10
28
VO-015G.0280
VO-025G.0450
G1
10
45
10
VO-025G.0900
90
VO-025G.1500
10
150
Indicating range is calibrated for vertical upward increasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
MATERIALS
housing
connectors
glass
piston
spring
magnet
seal
VO-...GA
aluminium anodized
brass Ms58
nickel plated
duran 50
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4571
hardferrite
NBR
VO-...GK
aluminium anodized
stainless steel 1.4571
duran 50
stainless steel 1.4571
stainless steel 1.4571
hardferrite
viton
92
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow VO-...GA/GK
ELECTRICAL DATA
[ BASIC Standard
No electrical components
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
015
025
G A
G
W
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
Accessories
PLUS
B
2
water
gas/air
oil
A
K
0005
0005
0010
0016
0040
0080
0220
0280
0450
0900
1500
[
S
[
[
[
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
0
indicating range
H2O
VOVOR-
015
VO.
METERING SUBSTANCES
VO-
1.2.
basic type
specification
Flow Indicator
Flow Indicator with switch head
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
female thread
manifold block connector for 70.1.VB.
connector material brass
connector material stainless steel
0.1 - 0.5 l/min
0.2 - 1.0 l/min
0.4 - 1.6 l/min
1 - 4 l/min
2 - 8 l/min
5 - 22 l/min
6 - 28 l/min
15 - 45 l/min
30 - 90 l/min
60 - 150 l/min
wiring 0.342 - change over
setting / switch ranges for oil or gas
scale 0 - 100%
special scale, special ranges
manifold block - data sheet 70.1.VB.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
93
Basic
Flowmeter
Novaflux NO-...GM/GK
1.3.
NO.
NO-015GM030
TECHNICAL DATA
G
PN
bar
Type
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless
steel
brass
NO-008GM015
50
G 1/4
50
NO-010GM015
G 3/8
NO-015GM030
50
G 1/2
G 3/4
NO-020GM050
50
NO-025GM060
50
G1
NO-008GK015
50
G 1/4
50
NO-010GK015
G 3/8
50
NO-015GK030
G 1/2
G 3/4
NO-020GK050
50
G1
50
NO-025GK060
Indicating range is calibrated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
15
15
30
50
60
15
15
30
50
60
indicating range
l/min H2O
X
mm
weight
kg
3 - 15
3 - 15
5 - 30
5 - 50
10 - 60
3 - 15
3 - 15
5 - 30
5 - 50
10 - 60
13
13
15
18
18
13
13
15
18
18
1.25
1.20
1.20
1.10
1.00
1.25
1.20
1.20
1.10
1.00
5% of full scale
minimal 1l/min
max. 90C
0.7bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
housing
pisiton
spring
support
magnet
seal
tube
NO-...GM
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4310
PVDF
oxyd 300
NBR / viton
acrylic (XT)
NO-...GK
94
Basic
Flowmeter
Novaflux NO-...GM/GK
1.3.
NO.
ELECTRICAL DATA
[ BASIC Standard
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
Indicate installation
position in your order
oil
NOMENCLATURE
008
010
015
020
025
G M
015
M
K
015
030
050
060
[
S
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
nominal
diameter
NONOK-
008
indicating
range
H2O
NO-
OPTIONS
S NOK- Flowmeter with switch unit plastic
free
1
brown
2
white
3
blue
4
black
l/min H2O
3- 12
5- 25
5- 40
10- 50
- switch unit
fixed to
pigeon tail
- direct scale
reference
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
95
Basic
Special applications
Flow control instruments AR-010GM
Flow control instrument for processes and original equipment
Mechanical flow control instrument for liquid or gaseous
media, with spring-supported
piston and magnetic triggering
of a reed switch. Sturdy construction made of brass.
l Inner thread DN 10
l Reed switch
l Ranges from 2-4 l/min
l Pressure rating PN 150
l Max. temperature 80 C
l Brass material
96
Why to use a
Basic
maintenance advantage
accurate setting
optional installation
Where to use a
Basic
Market segments
l High pressure
cleaners
l Oil separators
l Lubrication
l Cooling installations
l Painting robots
l Paper machines
Application
l Pump and gun control in cleaner devices
l Control of oil/water mix in separation processes
l Air control in automatic painting installations
l Manifold control and indication for oil feed to roller gears
98
Variable area
The technology
C
The float moves dependent
on the flow in the transparent conical metering tube,
indicating the actual flow
rate on the housing scale.
Application
l
l
l
l
Laboratory technology
Chemical industry
Process technology
Industrial metering tasks
Contents
Advantages
System description
100
Device descriptions
101
Technical data
Concept
Nominal diameter
4 - 50
Connection
PN
6 - 16
optional threshold
Adjustable
yes
Materials
l Switching
l Indicating
l Metering
99
Basic
System description
Device system
The float metering principle is a tried and trusted method of accurately
measuring liquid and gaseous metering materials. The float moves vertically in a transparent tube and indicates the current flow rate by its
respective position on the housing scale.
The devices can only be installed vertically and require a transparent
medium which allows a complete view of the float element.
Flow
The direct indication of the position without further functional components allows an extremely accurate metering result. In case magnets
are integrated in the float, triggering of threshold contacts or sensors
arranged outside the metering tube is possible. To this extent the float
system also represents an option for monitoring the flow or producing a
linear continuous output signal.
100
l
l
l
l
l
l
6
6
65
65
l
l
l
l
valve
valve
94
8
8
l
l
l
l
6
6
65
65
l
l
l
l
valve
valve
96
UK-044
65
98
UK-047
15
65
100
UK-048
20
65
102
UK-050
25
65
l
l
l
l
6
6
60
60
l
l
l
l
106
109
65
112
connection
type
8
8
UK-040
3
3
valve
valve
90
91
92
3
plastic
glass
UK-200
3
3
page
100
100
l
l
miscellaneous
water
10
10
m
m
aggressive
max. temperature C
l
l
gas/air
l
l
15 - 25
15 - 25
VL
oil
on site metering
l
l
output signal
90
90
indication
10
10
4
4
control
l
l
nominal diameter
l
l
GR-065
GR-150
GK
GKL
MMF
l standard
10 - 25
25 - 50
m standard option
special option
m
m
valve
104
101
Basic
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Koniflux GR-065GK
2.1.
GR.65
TECHNICAL DATA
NPT
GR-065AK0005G
Type
PN
bar
metering range
air Ncm/min
2 - 51
10
GR-065GK0005G
5 - 103
10
GR-065GK0010G
20 - 400
10
GR-065GK0040G
20 - 900
GR-065GK0090G
10
100 - 2580
GR-065GK0258G
10
100 - 3930
10
GR-065GK0393G
100 - 6000
GR-065GK0600G
10
150 - 10100
GR-065GK1010G
10
800 - 15750
GR-065GK1575G
10
700 - 23640
10
GR-065GK2500G
5 - 153
10
NPT 1/8"
GR-065GK0015K
10 - 298
GR-065GK0029K
10
40 - 855
GR-065GK0085K
10
50 - 1800
GR-065GK0180K
10
277 - 5030
10
GR-065GK0503K
300 - 7510
10
GR-065GK0751K
250 - 11450
10
GR-065GK1145K
400 - 18960
GR-065GK1896K
10
2000 - 29400
GR-065GK2940K
10
2000 - 43340
10
GR-065GK4334K
Scale in mm-increments. Conversion diagram mm/flowrate subject of to delivery.
metering range
water cm/min
float
stainless steel
float
glass
NPT 1/8"
tolerance
media temperature
0.5
0.2
2
2
2
3
10
10
18.2
55
90
130
235
375
570
0.5
0.9
1
3.27
5
5
10
40
50
21
50
144
220
335
660
880
1305
MATERIALS
metering tube
float
connector
seal
natural glass
glass or stainless steel
stainless steel
viton
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
102
weight
kg
Basic
variable area
Flowmeter
Koniflux GR-065GK
2.1.
GR.65
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
GRGRV-
065
065
0005
K
A
M
0005
0010
0015
0029
0040
0085
0090
0180
0258
0393
0503
0600
0751
1010
1145
1575
1896
2364
2940
4334
G
K
Special option
VARIO
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
metering range
GR-
0.9
0.2
1
2
2
3
2
5
3.27
5
10
10
10
40
50
- 21
- 18.2
- 50
- 55
- 90
- 144
- 130
- 220
- 235
- 334
- 375
- 560
- 570
- 880
-1305
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
cm/min water
SPECIAL APPLICATION
GR-150
Design with scale length 150mm
ranges on request
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
103
Basic
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Visoflow VL
2.3.
VL.
good repeatability
optional with limit switch
VLR-015GA018
TECHNICAL DATA
G
PN
bar
Type
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
VL-015GA002
10
1,5
VL-015GA003
10
3
VL-015GA008
10
8
VL-015GA012
10
12
VL-015GA018
10
18
G1
VL-025GA035
10
35
10
VL-025GA050
50
G1/2
VL-015GK002
10
1,5
VL-015GK003
10
3
VL-015GK008
10
8
VL-015GK012
10
12
18
VL-015GK018
10
G1
VL-025GK035
10
35
50
VL-025GK050
10
Metering range is indicated for vertical upward increasing flow.
stainless steel
brass
G1/2
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
metering range
l/min H2O
D
mm
H
mm
L
mm
X
mm
AF
mm
weight
kg
0.1 - 1.5
0.2 - 3
0.3 - 8
1 - 12
2 - 18
3 - 35
4 - 50
0.1 - 1.5
0.2 - 3
0.3 - 8
1 - 12
2 - 18
3 - 35
4 - 50
43
43
43
43
43
50
50
43
43
43
43
43
50
50
73
73
73
73
77
76
76
73
73
73
73
77
76
76
132
135
135
135
163
184
184
132
135
135
135
163
184
184
13
13
13
13
13
17
17
13
13
13
13
13
17
17
32
32
32
32
32
41
41
32
32
32
32
32
41
41
0.63
0.63
0.63
0.63
0.65
1.00
1.00
0.63
0.63
0.63
0.63
0.65
1.00
1.00
5% of full scale
max. 100C
0.01-0.2 bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
housing
connectors
glass
float
magnet
seal
VL-...GA
aluminium anodized
brass Ms58
nickel plated
duran 50
brass Ms58
nickel plated
hardferrite
NBR
VL-...GK
aluminium anodized
stainless steel 1.4571
duran 50
stainless steel 1.4571
hardferrite
viton
104
Basic
Flowmeter
Visoflow VL
variable area
RBASIC
Programme
option
ELECTRICAL DATA
Z BASIC Standard
No electrical components
MOUNTING POSITION
015
025
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
G A
G
W
water
gas/air
oil
A
K
002
002
003
008
012
018
035
050
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
0
metering range
H2O
VLVLR-
015
VL.
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
VL-
2.3.
basic type
specification
Flowmeter
Flowmeter with switch head
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
female thread
manifold block connector for 70.1.VB.
connector material brass
connector material stainless steel
0.1 - 1.5 l/min
0.2 - 3 l/min
0.3 - 8 l/min
1 - 12 l/min
2 - 18 l/min
3 - 35 l/min
4 - 50 l/min
wiring 0.342 - change over
setting / ranges for oil or gas
scale 0 - 100%
special scale, special ranges
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
105
Basic
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-020
2.1.
UK.20
UKV-020GML0005
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
NPT 1/8"
UK.-020G.W0050
UK.-020G.W0100
UK.-020G.W0240
UK.-020G.W0003
UK.-020G.W0006
UK.-020G.W0015
UK.-020G.W0040
UK.-020G.W0080
UK.-020G.L0000
UK.-020G.L0001
UK.-020G.L0005
UK.-020G.L0025
H2O
NPT
air
NPT 1/8"
tolerance
media temperature
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
0.7 Nl/min
1.2 Nl/min
6.0 Nl/min
30.0 Nl/min
metering range
5
10
20
0.2
0.5
1
4
10
0.04
0.1
0.4
2
- 50 cm/min
- 100 cm/min
- 240 cm/min
3 l/h
6 l/h
- 15 l/h
- 40 l/h
- 80 l/h
- 0,5 Nl/min
1 Nl/min
5 Nl/min
- 25 Nl/min
5% of full scale
max. 65C
MATERIALS
housing
float
buffers
connectors
seal
valve
UK-020GM
acrylic
glass/stainless steel
stainless steel
brass
NBR
brass/NBR
UK-020GK
acrylic
glass/stainless steel
stainless steel
stainless steel
viton
stainless steel/viton
106
weight
kg
0.13
0.13
Basic
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-020
variable area
2.1.
UK.20
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
020
Special option
VARIO
M
K
W0050
W0050
W0100
W0240
W0003
W0006
W0015
W0040
W0080
L0000
L0001
L0005
L0025
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
metering range
H2O
UKUKV-
020
metering
range
air
UK-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
107
Basic
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-040
2.1.
UK.40
UKV-040GML0010
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
NPT 1/8"
UK.-040G.W0003
UK.-040G.W0008
UK.-040G.W0014
UK.-040G.W0040
UK.-040G.W0080
UK.-040G.W0220
UK.-040G.L0001
UK.-040G.L0005
UK.-040G.L0010
UK.-040G.L0020
UK.-040G.L0030
UK.-040G.L0050
UK.-040G.L0100
H2O
NPT
air
NPT 1/8"
tolerance
media temperature
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
6 l/min
1.2 Nl/min
6.0 Nl/min
12.0 Nl/min
24.0 Nl/min
36.0 Nl/min
60.0 Nl/min
120.0 Nl/min
metering range
0.2
0.6
1
4
8
20
0.1
0.4
1
2
3
4
10
3
8
14
40
80
220
1
5
10
20
30
50
100
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
3% of full scale
max. 65C
MATERIALS
housing
float
buffers
connectors
seal
valve
UK-040GM
acrylic
glass/stainless steel
stainless steel
brass
NBR
brass/NBR
UK-040GK
acrylic
glass/stainless steel
stainless steel
stainless steel
viton
stainless steel/viton
108
weight
kg
0.24
0.24
Basic
variable area
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-040
2.1.
UK.40
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
040
Special option
VARIO
M
K
W0003
W0003
W0008
W0014
W0040
W0080
W0220
L0001
L0005
L0010
L0020
L0030
L0050
L0100
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
metering range
H2O
UKUKV-
040
metering range
air
UK-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
109
Basic
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-044
2.1.
UK.44
UK-044AHW0050
H2O
TECHNICAL DATA
NPT
Type
NPT 1/4"
UK-044AHW0050
UK-044AHW0100
UK-044AHW0230
UK-044AHL1700
UK-044AHL3000
UK-044AHL8500
air
NPT 1/4"
tolerance
media temperature
PN
bar
6
6
6
6
6
6
metering range
4
15
30
200
500
1000
50
100
230
1700
3000
8500
l/h
l/h
l/h
Nl/h
Nl/h
Nl/h
5% of full scale
max. 65C
MATERIALS
housing
float
buffers
connectors
seal
acrylic
aluminuim
stainless steel
PVC
NBR
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
110
weight
kg
0.1
0.1
Basic
variable area
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-044
2.1.
UK.44
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
UK-
044
044
Special option
VARIO
A
A
W0050
W0050
W0100
W0230
L1700
L3000
L8500
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
metering
range
UK-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
111
Basic
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-047
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
2.3.
UK.47
UK-047GHL0070
H2O
TECHNICAL DATA
NPT
Type
NPT 1/2"
UK-047GHW0010
UK-047GHW0020
UK-047GHW0040
UK-047GHL0034
UK-047GHL0070
UK-047GHL0150
air
NPT 1/2"
tolerance
media temperature
PN
bar
6
6
6
6
6
6
weight
kg
metering range
dual scale LPM and LPH
2
2
4
80
100
150
10
20
40
340
700
1500
l/min
l/min
l/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
120
120
240
4800
6000
9000
600
1200
2400
20400
42000
90000
3% of full scale
max. 65C
MATERIALS
housing
float
connectors
seal
acrylic
aluminuim / stainless steel
PVC
NBR
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
112
l/h
l/h
l/h
Nl/h
Nl/h
Nl/h
0.35
0.35
Basic
variable area
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-047
2.3.
UK.47
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
UK-
047
047
Special option
VARIO
G
G
W0010
W0010
W0020
W0040
L0034
L0070
L0150
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
metering
range
UK-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
113
Basic
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-048
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
2.3.
UK.48
UK-048GHW0045
H2O
TECHNICAL DATA
NPT
Type
NPT 3/4"
UK-048GHW0045
UK-048GHW0060
UK-048GHW0070
UK-048GHL0140
UK-048GHL0180
UK-048GHL0220
air
NPT 3/4"
tolerance
media temperature
metering range
dual scale LPM and LPH
PN
bar
6
6
6
6
6
6
5
6
8
150
200
200
45
60
70
1400
1800
2200
l/min
l/min
l/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
300
360
480
9000
12000
12000
weight
kg
2700
3600
4200
84000
108000
132000
3% of full scale
max. 65C
MATERIALS
housing
float
connectors
seal
acrylic
aluminuim / stainless steel
PVC
NBR
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
114
l/h
l/h
l/h
Nl/h
Nl/h
Nl/h
0.45
0.45
Basic
variable area
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-048
2.3.
UK.48
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
UK-
048
048
Special option
VARIO
G
G
W0010
W0045
W0060
W0070
L0140
L0180
L0220
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
metering
range
UK-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
115
Basic
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-050
2.3.
UK.50
UKV-050GHW0036
H2O
TECHNICAL DATA
NPT
Type
NPT 1"
UK.-050GHW0019
UK.-050GHW0036
UK.-050GHW0075
UK.-050GHL0700
UK.-050GHL1400
UK.-050GHL3000
air
NPT 1"
tolerance
media temperature
PN
bar
6
6
6
6
6
6
Qmax.recom.
21
44
90
850
1700
4000
l/min
l/min
l/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
metering range
1 - 19
4 - 36
5 - 75
100 - 700
100 - 1400
400 - 3000
l/min
l/min
l/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
Nl/min
2% of full scale
max. 65C
MATERIALS
housing
float
buffers
connectors
seal
acrylic
stainless steel
stainless steel
PVC
NBR
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
116
weight
kg
0.8
0.8
Basic
Flowmeter
Koniflux UK-050
variable area
2.3.
UK.50
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
Soecial option
VARIO
W0019
W0019
W0036
W0075
L0700
L1400
L3000
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
H2O
050
air
UKUKV-
050
metering range
UK-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
117
Basic
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Koniflux GK-...GT
2.2.
GK.
GK-010GTW0160PO
TECHNICAL DATA
Rp
Type
Rp 3/8
GK-010GTW0025
GK-010GTW0040
GK-010GTW0060
GK-010GTW0100
GK-010GTW0160
GK-015GTW0160
GK-015GTW0250
GK-020GTW0160
GK-020GTW0250
GK-020GTW0400
GK-020GTW06..
GK-025GTW0250
GK-025GTW0400
GK-025GTW06..
GK-010GTL0360
GK-010GTL0550
GK-010GTL0900
GK-010GTL0015
GK-010GTL0024
GK-015GTL0038
GK-015GTL0048
GK-020GTL0025
GK-020GTL0037
GK-020GTL00..
GK-025GTL0040
GK-025GTL0060
GK-025GTL0100
GK-025GTL0160
H2O
Rp 1/2
Rp 3/4
Rp 1
Rp 3/8
air
Rp 1/2
Rp 3/4
Rp 1
polypropylene
pressure
tolerance
-20
15
15
without magnet
with magnet
without/with magnet
2 - 25
2 - 40
5 - 60
10 - 100
15 - 160
15 - 160
20 - 250
15 - 160
20 - 250
40 - 400
60 - 640
20 - 250
40 - 400
60 - 640
20 - 360
50 - 550
100 - 900
0.15- 1.5
0.2 - 2.4
0.4 - 3.8
0.4 - 4.8
0.2 - 2.5
0.25- 3.75
0.5 - 5.5
0.4 - 4
0.5 - 6
1 - 10
1 - 16
2 - 25
2 - 40
5 - 60
10 - 100
15 - 160
15 - 160
20 - 250
15 - 160
20 - 250
40 - 400
60 - 640
20 - 250
40 - 400
60 - 640
0.75- 6.5
1 - 10
2 - 16
4 - 40
5 - 60
10 - 100
15 - 160
15 - 160
20 - 250
20 - 250
40 - 400
60 - 600
40 - 400
50 - 650
-
PN15
1% of full scale
and 3% of measured value
max. 60C
max. 20mbar
media temperature
pressure loss
tube
trogamid
polysulfon
stainless steel
0
15
15
20
15
15
30
13,5
14
temperature C
40
50
60
12 10,7 9,5
13
12
11
bar
L
L1 L2
mm mm mm
l/h
207
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
215
l/h
l/h
230
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
250
l/h
l/h
Nl/h
207
Nl/h
Nl/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h 215
Nm/h
Nm/h 230
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h 250
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
GK-...G
180
165
3/4
32
12
0.18
185
170
41
13
0.30
201
185 1 1/4
50
16
0.50
219
200 1 1/2
55
19
0.65
180
165
3/4
32
12
0.18
185
170
41
13
0.30
201
185 1 1/4
50
16
0.50
219
200 1 1/2
55
19
0.65
GK-...M
Measurements on request
70 80 90 100
9,7 8,5 7,7 6,0
MATERIALS
tube
float
connector
seal
trogamid
polypropylene
cast iron
viton
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
118
SW X weight
kg
mm mm
Basic
Flowmeter
Koniflux GK-...GT
variable area
ELECTRICAL DATA
Z BASIC Standard
2.2.
GK.
PLUS accessories
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
For combinations see table "technical data".
NOMENCLATURE
T
W0025 PO
W0060
W0100
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
Z
R
Z
Z
R
Z
Z
W0160
W0250
W0400
W0600
W0640
W0650
L0360
L0550
L0900
L0015
L0024
L0025
L0037
L0038
L0040
L0048
L0055
L0060
L0065
L0100
Z
R
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
Z
Z
R
Z
R
R
R
R
0
Accessories PLUS
010
015
020
025
G
M
T
P
W0025
W0040
L0160
PO
PM
KO
KM
H2O
air
010
metering range
GK-
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 10 - Rp3/8
nominal diameter DN 15 - Rp1/2
nominal diameter DN 20 - Rp3/4
nominal diameter DN 25 - Rp1
female thread Rp cast iron, PN15
threaded connector with glue fittings PVC, PN10
measuring tube trogamid
measuring tube polysulfon (max. temperature 100C)
Z R
2 - 25 l/h
Z R
2 - 40 l/h
R R
4 - 40 l/h
Z R R R
5 - 60 l/h
Z R R R
10 - 100 l/h
Z R R R
15 - 160 l/h
Z R
Z
Z R R R
Z
20 - 250 l/h
Z R
Z
Z R R R Z Z
40 - 400 l/h
R R
R
60 - 600 l/h
Z Z
Z R
60 - 640 l/h
R R R
50 - 650 l/h
Z
20 - 360 Nl/h
Z
50 - 550 Nl/h
Z
100 - 900 Nl/h
Z
0.15- 1.5 Nm/h
Z
0.2 - 2.4 Nm/h
Z
Z
0.2 - 2.5 Nm/h
Z
Z
0.25- 3.75 Nm/h
Z
0.4 - 3.8 Nm/h
Z
Z
0.4 - 4
Nm/h
Z
0.4 - 4.8 Nm/h
Z
Z
0.5 - 5.5 Nm/h
Z
Z
0.5 - 6
Nm/h
R
R
0.75- 6.5 Nm/h
Z
Z R
1 - 10
Nm/h
Z
Z
1 - 16
Nm/h
R
R
2 - 16
Nm/h
float polypropylene without magnet
float polypropylene with magnet
float stainless steel without magnet
float stainless steel with magnet
scale in %
actual metering ranges referring to pressure and temperature
special scales
Only for float with magnet.
switch unit
Description see next page.
contin.signal convert.
Z
Z
R
Z
Z
Z Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
119
Basic
Flowmeter
Koniflux GK-...GT
variable area
2.2.
GK.
ACCESSORIES
GKEH-1256
for DN 10-20
maximum switch unit plastic
bistable reed switch
wiring diagram 0.212 n.o.
250 V AC 0.2 A 10 VA
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.035 kg
GKEL-1257
for DN 10-20
minimal switch unit plastic
bistable reed switch
wiring diagram 0.214 n.c.
250 V AC 0.2 A 10 VA
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.035 kg
GKEH-1251
for DN 25
maximum switch unit plastic
bistable reed switch
wiring diagram 0.212 n.o.
250 V AC 0.2 A 10 VA
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.075 kg
GKEL-1252
for DN 25
minimal switch unit plastic
bistable reed switch
wiring diagram 0.214 n.c.
250 V AC 0.2 A 10 VA
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.075 kg
GKK-1271
continuous signal converter plastic
reed switch chain
24 V DC
exit signal: 0 - 10 k-Ohm
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.07 kg
1
2
3
GKI-1273 / GKI-1273-1
Type GKI-1273 for DN10-20
Type GKI-1273-1 for DN25
continuous signal converter plastic
reed switch chain with integrated signal convertor
supply11-40 V DC depending on ohmic resistance
ohmic resistance max. 1500
exit signal: 4 - 20 mA
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.08 kg
voltage
40
30
20
10
500
1000
burden
1500
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
120
Basic
variable area
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Koniflux GKL-...GT
2.2.
GKL.
GKL-050GTW0064PO
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
Rp 1
Rp 1 1/4
GKL-025GTW1000
GKL-032GTW1000
GKL-032GTW1600
GKL-040GTW1600
GKL-040GTW2500
GKL-040GTW3300
GKL-050GTW0025
GKL-050GTW0040
GKL-050GTW0064
GKL-025GTL0100
GKL-025GTL0160
GKL-025GTL0250
GKL-032GTL0160
GKL-032GTL0250
GKL-032GTL0400
GKL-032GTL0640
GKL-040GTL0250
GKL-040GTL0400
GKL-040GTL0500
GKL-040GTL0600
GKL-050GTL0400
GKL-050GTL0640
GKL-050GTL1000
GKL-050GTL1500
GKL-050GTL2500
polypropylene
H2O
without magnet
Rp 1 1/2
Rp 2
Rp 1
air
Rp 1 1/4
Rp 1 1/2
Rp 2
L1 L2
L
mm mm mm
Rp
with magnet
100 - 1000
100 - 1000
100 - 1000
100 - 1000
150 - 1600
150 - 1600
200 - 1600
200 - 1600
300 - 2500
300 - 2500
300 - 3300
300 - 3300
0.2 - 2.5 0.2 - 2.5
0.4 - 4
0.4 - 4
0.6 - 6.4 0.6 - 6.4
1 - 10
1.25- 10
1.5 - 16
1.5 - 16
3 - 25
1.5 - 16
2 - 25
4 - 40
4 - 40
6 - 64
2 - 25
4 - 40
5 - 50
5 - 60
4 - 40
6 - 64
10 - 100
15 - 160
20 - 250
stainless steel
without/with magnet
100 - 1000
150 - 1600
200 - 2500
0.4 - 4
0.6 - 6.4
-
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
l/h
m/h
m/h
m/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
Nm/h
PN15
1% of full scale
and 3% of measured value
max. 60C
max. 20mbar
media temperature
pressure loss
tube
trogamid
polysulfon
-20
15
15
0
15
15
20
15
15
30
13,5
14
temperature C
40
50
60
12 10,7 9,5
13
12
11
bar
SW X weight
mm mm
kg
402
410
369
370
350
350
1 1/2
2
55
66
17
19
0.75
1.25
414
372
350
2 1/4
74
20
1.75
420
374
350
2 3/4
90
24
2.40
402
369
350
1 1/2
55
17
0.75
410
370
350
66
19
1.25
414
372
350
2 1/4
74
20
1.75
420
374
350
2 3/4
90
24
2.4
GKL-...G
pressure
tolerance
GKL-...M
Measurements on request
70 80 90 100
9,7 8,5 7,7 6,0
MATERIALS
tube
float
connector
seal
trogamid
polypropylene
cast iron
viton
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
121
Basic
Flowmeter
Koniflux GKL-...GT
variable area
2.2.
GKL.
ELECTRICAL DATA
Z BASIC Standard
PLUS accessories
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
W1000 PO
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
Z
R
T
P
W1000
Z
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
W1600
W2500
W3300
W0025
W0040
W0064
L0100
L0160
L0250
Z
Z
L0400
L0500
L0600
Z
R
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
R
R
R
0
Accessories PLUS
L0640
L1000
L1500
L2500
PO
PM
KO
KM
H2O
G
M
Luft
025
032
040
050
Messbereich
GKL- 025
Z
Z
Z
Z
- With gaseous media indicate pressure (relative or absolute), temperature and metering substance, e.g. air (metering range on request)
ZBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
122
Z
R
Z
R
Z
Basic
Flowmeter
Koniflux GKL-...GT
variable area
2.2.
GKL.
ACCESSORIES
GKEH-1251
maximum switch unit plastic
bistable reed switch
wiring diagram 0.212 n.o.
250 V AC 0.2 A 10 VA
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.075 kg
GKEL-1252
minimal switch unit plastic
bistable reed switch
wiring diagram 0.214 n.c.
250 V AC 0.2 A 10 VA
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.075 kg
GKK-1270
continuous signal converter plastic
reed switch chain
24 V DC
exit signal: 0 - 10 k-Ohm
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.07 kg
1
2
3
GKI-1272
continuous signal converter plastic
reed switch chain with integrated signal converter
supply11-40 V DC depending on ohmic resistance
ohmic resistance max. 1500
exit signal: 4 - 20 mA
plug DIN 43650-B
protection class IP 65
additional weight 0.08 kg
voltage
40
U
1
2
J
30
20
10
500
1000
burden
1500
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
123
Basic
Special applications
Flow meter MMF
Flow meter for respiratory air and oxygen in medical applications.
The flow meters of the Med-Flow series have been specially developed
for use in medical environments. The devices provide an extremely accurate and reliable method of metering and dosing respiratory air or
oxygen.
The sturdy brass base and LEXAN metering and protective tubes contribute to this performance. The precision stainless steel valve makes
exact setting and reliable blocking possible.
The metering ranges have been designed for an operating pressure of
3.5 bar. Other calibration is available on request.
l
l
l
l
Ranges up to 15 l/min
Temperature max. 65 C
Pressure max. 6.9 bar
Materials Lexan, brass, stainless steel, NBR
Type
Range
Oxygen
Air
Nl/min
124
Accuracy
Nl/min
MMF-003
0.125 - 3.5
0.2
MMF-008
0.25 - 8
0.4
MMF-015
0.5 - 15
0.6
Why to use a
Basic
optimal visibility
versatility
stability
l Buffer spring
good readability
regulation
125
Where to use a
Basic
Market segments
l Oxygen generator
l Medical installation
l Dosage
l Welding
Application
l Monitoring of oxygen supply or output
l Measurement of breathing air
l Measurement of substances in mixing operations
l Monitoring of gas supplies during welding
126
Paddle
The technology
D
Flow-dependent paddle movement
is transformed magnetically contactless to adjustable contacts
and/or pointer metering units.
Application
Contents
l Pump monitoring
l Run dry protection
Paddle
128
dynamic flap
129
Device descriptions
131
Advantages
l Nominal diameters DN 10 to DN 300
l Low pressure loss
l Dirt-resistant
Technical data
Concept
Nominal diameter
10 - 300
Connection
PN
6 - 25
Adjustable
yes
Materials
l Switching
l Metering
127
Basic
System description
Device system
The Honsberg paddle system for monitoring and metering liquid and
gaseous materials represents an economical alternative with high
operational safety for monitoring and metering flow quantities in industrial
plant construction.
No flow
Flow
UM3
CRG
UZ
TZ1
128
Version A
Version B
CRG/UB1
4
8
10
20
60
80
100
120
Viscosity mm/s
30
4
8
10
20
58
78
96
117
60
3.8
7.6
9
19
55
74
92
111
115
3.5
7
8.5
18
53
70
87
107
D
220
3
6.6
8
17.5
48
64
81
96
With air and gases, the functional ratio in relation to water is approx.
1:15, i.e. 1 l/min of water corresponds to approx. 15 NI/min of air,
whereby temperature, density and operating pressure play a special role
here.
In these cases the devices are made according to customer specification.
Example:
Viscosity
Flow rate
1 mm/s
115 mm/s
4.0 l/min
3.5 l/min
Dynamic flap
The flowing liquids move a thin springy flap that covers the
entire flow area. A magnet on the flap creates a changing
magnetic field, which is detected by a Hall sensor, when the
flap is moved. Due to the spring-like quality of the flap and the
molded stop, even strong impacts caused by the water are
absorbed well. The low number of parts that are touched by
the liquids ensure less contamination und smooth operation.
no flow
flow
129
Basic
TZ1
The function of the threshold [TZ1, UZ] is indicated via a trailing pointer
or can optionally be confirmed by an LED display.
UZ
130
oil
air/gas
110
110
l
l
3
3
3
3
134
l
l
25
25
110
110
l
l
3
3
3
3
25
25
110
110
l
l
3
3
3
3
l
l
l
25
25
25
110
110
110
l
l
l
3
3
3
3
3
3
142
UI
16
60
141
UB1
25-200
25-200
40-200
40-200
l
l
l
l
16
16
16
16
140
140
140
140
l
l
l
l
3
3
3
3
CM2K
l
l
25
25
110
110
l
l
3
3
CRG
l
l
11
11
110
110
l
l
3
3
VM
l
l
16
16
90
90
l
l
3
3
TZ1
l
m
16
l
90
16
l
90
3
l
m
m
l
l
l
l
6
6
100
100
l
l
3
3
m
m
m
16
16
16
70
70
70
l
l
l
type
Paddle
UMK3
UZ
Dynamic flap
XF
l standard
8 - 20
8 - 20
8 - 20
m standard option
special option
l
l
l
l
l
l
page
water
25
25
miscellaneous
max. temperature C
aggressive
132
on site metering
3
3
output signal
3
3
indication
l
l
control
110
110
connection
25
25
nominal diameter
l
l
UR3K
136
Honsberg
combi138
nation
System
140
144
3
3
146
mYR
148
3
150
152
3
154
3
156
3
131
Basic
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UR3K-...GM/GK
3.1.
UR3K.G
good repeatability
low pressure loss
dirt resistant
hermetic separation of electrical
and hydraulic components
easy adjustment of switch
UR3K-015GM065
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax.recom.
l/min H2O
stainless steel
brass
UR3K-010GM050
G 3/8
25
10
UR3K-015GM065
G 1/2
25
20
UR3K-020GM085
G 3/4
25
40
G1
UR3K-025GM150
25
60
G 1 1/4
UR3K-032GM270
25
80
G 1 1/2
25
UR3K-040GM440
100
G2
UR3K-050GM690
25
150
G 3/8
UR3K-010GK050
10
25
G 1/2
20
UR3K-015GK065
25
G 3/4
40
UR3K-020GK085
25
G1
UR3K-025GK150
25
60
UR3K-032GK270
80
G 1 1/4
25
UR3K-040GK440
100
G 1 1/2
25
G2
25
UR3K-050GK690
150
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
L
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
3.5 - 5
5 - 6.5
6 - 8.5
12 - 15
20 - 27
34 - 44
54 - 69
3.5 - 5
5 - 6.5
6 - 8.5
12 - 15
20 - 27
34 - 44
54 - 69
87
87
88
92
96
99
108
87
87
88
92
96
99
108
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
10
10
12
12
12
12
12
10
10
12
12
12
12
12
0.35
0.35
0.35
0.40
0.55
0.60
1.00
0.40
0.41
0.35
0.45
0.55
0.70
1.00
MATERIALS
housing
body
paddle
spring
magnet
seal
UR3K-...GM
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4301 ;
1.4571
stainless steel 1.4310
oxyd 300
NBR
UR3K-...GK
132
Basic
paddle
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UR3K-...GM/GK
3.1.
UR3K.G
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
010
015
020
025
032
040
050
G M
Special option
VARIO
M
K
050
050
065
085
150
270
440
690
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
0
nominal diameter
010
adjusable range
H2O horizontal
UR3K-
female thread
brass
stainless steel
male thread
brass
POM
welding, soldering
glue socket
solder fitting
glue fitting
copper
PVC
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
133
Basic
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UR3K-...VM/VK
3.1.
UR3K.V
good repeatability
low pressure loss
dirt resistant
hermetic separation of electrical
and hydraulic components
easy adjustment of switch
UR3K-025VM
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless steel
brass
15
UR3K-015VM
25
20
40
20
25
UR3K-025VM
25
80
32
100
40
150
50
UR3K-050VM
200
25
65
400
80
600
15
UR3K-015VK
25
20
20
40
25
UR3K-025VK
25
80
32
100
40
150
200
50
UR3K-050VK
25
400
65
80
600
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
Calibrated in tube DIN2448 standard wall thickness.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
D
mm
A
mm
B
mm
weight
kg
8.5 - 11
14 - 19
15 - 20
39 - 52
49 - 64
68 - 84
127 - 163
189 - 248
8.5 - 11
14 - 19
15 - 20
39 - 52
49 - 64
68 - 84
127 - 163
189 - 248
18.5
10
0.21
27.0
12
16
0.22
40.5
12
19
0.23
18.5
10
0.21
27.0
12
16
0.22
40.5
12
19
0.23
MATERIALS
socket
body
paddle
spring
magnet
seal
UR3K-...VM
brass Ms58
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4301 ;
1.4571
stainless steel 1.4310
oxyd 300
NBR
UR3K-...VK
134
Basic
paddle
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UR3K-...VM/VK
3.1.
UR3K.V
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
UR3K-
015
015
025
050
V M
Special option
VARIO
M
K
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
0
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15-20
nominal diameter DN 25-40
nominal diameter DN 50-80
welding socket
brass design
stainless steel design
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
contact for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
minimal flow range
INSTALLATION RECOMMENDATIONS
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
135
Basic
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UM3K-...GM/GK
3.1.
UM3K.G
good repeatability
low pressure loss
dirt resistant
hermetic separation of electrical
and hydraulic components
high switch capability
UM3K-015GM065
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless steel
brass
10
G 3/8
UM3K-010GM055
25
UM3K-015GM070
G 1/2
25
20
UM3K-020GM100
G 3/4
25
40
UM3K-025GM180
60
G1
25
UM3K-032GM300
25
G 1 1/4
80
UM3K-040GM500
25
100
G 1 1/2
UM3K-050GM930
25
150
G2
G 3/8
UM3K-010GK055
25
10
UM3K-015GK070
G 1/2
25
20
G 3/4
UM3K-020GK100
25
40
G1
UM3K-025GK180
25
60
G 1 1/4
UM3K-032GK300
25
80
G 1 1/2
UM3K-040GK500
25
100
25
150
G2
UM3K-050GK930
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
L
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
4 - 5.5
5.5 - 7
7.5 - 10
14 - 18
22 - 30
37 - 50
67 - 93
4 - 5.5
5.5 - 7
7.5 - 10
14 - 18
22 - 30
37 - 50
67 - 93
87
87
88
92
96
99
108
87
87
88
92
96
99
108
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
10
10
12
12
12
12
12
10
10
12
12
12
12
12
0.35
0.35
0.35
0.40
0.55
0.60
1.00
0.40
0.41
0.35
0.45
0.55
0.70
1.00
MATERIALS
housing
body
paddle
spring
magnet
seal
UM3K-...GM
brass Ms58
nickel plated
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4301 ;
1.4571
stainless steel 1.4310
oxyd 300
NBR
UM3K-...GK
viton
136
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UM3K-...GM/GK
paddle
ELECTRICAL DATA
QBASIC
Programme
options
wiring 0.342
MOUNTING POSITION
3.1.
UM3K.G
diode red
wiring 0.208
diode red/green
wiring 0.347
green
red
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
10
15
20
25
32
40
50
G M
Programme option
BASIC
M
K
050
055
070
100
018
300
500
930
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Special option
VARIO
nominal diameter
10
Verstellbereich
H2O horizontal
UM3K-
female thread
brass
stainless steel
male thread
brass
POM
welding, soldering
glue socket
solder fitting
glue fitting
copper
PVC
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
137
Basic
Paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UM3K-...VM/VK
3.1.
UM3K.V
good repeatability
low pressure loss
dirt resistant
hermetic separation of electrical
and hydraulic components
high switch capability
easy adjustment of switch
UM3K-015VM
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless steel
brass
20
15
UM3K-015VM
25
40
20
80
UM3K-025VM
25
25
32
100
150
40
50
25
200
UM3K-050VM
65
400
80
600
20
25
15
UM3K-015VK
40
20
25
80
25
UM3K-025VK
32
100
150
40
UM3K-050VK
25
50
200
65
400
80
600
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
Calibrated in tube DIN2448 standard wall thickness.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
D
mm
A
mm
B
mm
weight
kg
10 - 13
17.5 - 22
18 - 22.5
44 - 55.5
55.5 - 72
75 - 90
151 - 186
228 - 268
10 - 13
17.5 - 22
18 - 22.5
44 - 55.5
55.5 - 72
75 - 90
151 - 186
228 - 268
18.5
10
0.21
27.0
12
16
0.22
40.5
12
19
0.23
18.5
10
0.21
27.0
12
16
0.22
40.5
12
19
0.23
MATERIALS
socket
body
paddle
spring
magnet
seal
UM3K-...VM
brass Ms58
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4301 ;
1.4571
stainless steel 1.4310
oxyd 300
NBR
UM3K-...VK
138
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UM3K-...VM/VK
Paddle
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
QBASIC
Programme
options
wiring 0.342
3.1.
UM3K.V
diode red
wiring 0.208
diode red/green
wiring 0.347
green
red
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
UM3K-
015
015
025
050
Programme option
BASIC
V M
M
K
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Special option
VARIO
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15-20
nominal diameter DN 25-40
nominal diameter DN 50-80
welding socket
brass design
stainless steel design
wiring 0.208 - diode red integrated in plug DIN 43650-A
wiring 0.347 - diode red/green integrated in plug DIN 43650-A
wiring 0.342
gold-plated micro switch 125 V AC / 30 V DC / 100mA
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
contact for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
minimal flow range
INSTALLATION RECOMMENDATIONS
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
139
Basic
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UR1/UR2-...GM/GK
3.1.
UR1/2.G
good repeatability
low pressure loss
dirt resistant
hermetic separation of electrical
and hydraulic components
stress free fixation of switch unit by plastic cap
UR1-020GM
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax.recom.
l/min H2O
stainless steel
brass
UR.-010GM
25
10
G 3/8
UR.-015GM
25
20
G 1/2
UR.-020GM
G 3/4
25
40
UR.-025GM
G1
25
60
G 1 1/4
UR.-032GM
25
80
100
UR.-040GM
G 1 1/2
25
UR.-050GM
G2
25
150
10
UR.-010GK
G 3/8
25
UR.-015GK
20
G 1/2
25
40
UR.-020GK
25
G 3/4
G1
UR.-025GK
25
60
G 1 1/4
25
UR.-032GK
80
G 1 1/2
100
UR.-040GK
25
G2
UR.-050GK
25
150
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
L
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
2.5 - 3.5
4 - 4.5
5 - 6
9.5 - 11.5
13.5 - 17.5
30 - 38
42 - 53
2.5 - 3.5
4 - 4.5
5 - 6
9.5 - 11.5
13.5 - 17.5
30 - 38
42 - 53
81
81
82
86
90
93
102
81
81
82
86
90
93
102
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
10
10
12
12
12
12
12
10
10
12
12
12
12
12
0,35
0,35
0,35
0,40
0,55
0,60
1,00
0,40
0,41
0,35
0,45
0,55
0,70
1,00
MATERIALS
housing
body
paddle
spring
magnet
seal
UR.-...GM
brass Ms58
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4301 ;
1.4571
stainless steel 1.4310
oxyd 300
NBR
UR.-...GK
140
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UR1/UR2-...GM/GK
paddle
3.1.
UR1/2.G
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch
wiring 0.225
n.c. or n.o. depending on installation position
230 V AC 1A 50VA
1.5 m cable
protection class IP 65
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
brow n blue
brow n blue
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
010
UR1UR2-
010
015
020
025
032
040
050
G M
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
M
K
A
Special option
VARIO
nominal diameter
UR1-
SPECIAL APPLICATIONS
UR2 plastic
with fitting male thread plastic or brass G1/2A
or fitting female thread G3/8 - G2
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
141
Basic
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UR1/UR2-...VM/VK
3.1.
UR1/2.V
good repeatability
low pressure loss
dirt resistant
hermetic separation of electrical
and hydraulic components
stress free fixation of switch unit by plastic cap
UR1-015VM
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
stainless steel
brass
15
20
UR.-015VM
25
40
20
25
25
80
UR.-025VM
32
100
40
150
25
50
UR.-050VM
200
65
400
80
600
20
15
UR.-015VK
25
20
40
UR.-025VK
25
80
25
100
32
150
40
50
UR.-050VK
25
200
65
400
80
600
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
Calibrated in tube DIN2448 standard wall thickness.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
H
mm
D
mm
A
mm
B
mm
weight
kg
5 - 6.5
10 - 15.5
11 - 13
26 - 33
37 - 42.5
47.5 - 60
95 - 117
147 - 179
4.6 - 6.3
9.1 - 12
10 - 12.8
23.7 - 32
33.7 - 41.2
43.2 - 58.2
86.5 - 113
134 - 174
18.0
13
0.21
27.5
12
16
0.22
42.0
12
19
0.23
18.0
13
0.21
27.5
12
16
0.22
42.0
12
19
0.23
MATERIALS
socket
body
paddle
spring
magnet
seal
UR.-...VM
brass Ms58
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4301 ;
1.4571
stainless steel 1.4310
oxyd 300
NBR
UR.-...VK
142
Basic
paddle
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UR1/UR2-...VM/VK
3.1.
UR1/2.V
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch
wiring 0.225
n.c. or n.o. depending on installation position
230 V AC 1A 50VA
1.5 m cable
protection class IP 65
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
brow n
brow n blue
blue
water
gas/air
oil
NOMENCLATURE
UR1-
015
UR1UR2-
015
025
050
V M
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
M
K
A
Q
0
Special option
VARIO
basic type
specification
switch unit brass
switch unit and body plastic (PN10 - Tmax. 80C - cable 0,5 m)
nominal diameter DN 15-20
nominal diameter DN 25-40
nominal diameter DN 50-80
welding socket
brass design
stainless steel design
switch unit ATEX (product information 92.1.U1)
setting / adjustable ranges for oil or gas
special cable length
INSTALLATION RECOMMENDATIONS
SPECIAL APPLICATIONS
UR1-015HM
body male thread G1/2A
UR1-032HM
body with union and
male thread G1/2A
All technical changes reserved
lBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
143
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UB1
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
3.1.
UB1.
transparent
cover
UB1-032EM
full visibility
of operation
contact setting
UB1-025HM
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
m/h H2O
4
25
16
8
32
16
12
40
16
20
50
16
30
16
65
45
80
16
75
100
16
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
DN 25-32 only male thread design, DN 125-200 on request
media temperature
ambient temperature
tolerance
average pressure loss
hysteresis
weight
adjustable range
m/h H2O
Paddel 1
1.2 - 2.0
1.4 - 2.5
2.3 - 3.8
5.1 - 7.9
9.5 - 16.7
16.0 - 24.9
21.6 - 34.0
Paddel 1,2
1.9 - 3.4
4.7 - 8.3
8.7 - 14.1
12.8 - 20.1
Paddel 1,2,3
4.4 - 8.0
8.4 - 13.9
Paddel 1,2,3,4
7.0 - 12.4
max. 140C
-20..+70C
15% of full scale
0,08 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.1 m/h
1.3 kg male thread design
2.5 kg socket flange design
WERKSTOFFE
housing
paddle
bellow
cap
flange/socket
seal
UB1-.M
brass Ms58
s.s. 1.4305/1.4310
s.s 1.4541
PC
Rg5/Ms
NBR
UB1-.K
s.s. 1.4305
s.s. 1.4305/1.4310
s.s. 1.4541
PC
s.s. 1.4305
viton
144
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest UB1
paddle
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
3.1.
UB1.
A max.
resistive
6A
6A
6A
6A
A max.
induktive
1,5A
2A
5A
6A
min.
4V
A min.
1mA
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
UB1-
025H
025H
032E
Programme option
BASIC
M
M
K
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
basic type
specification
male thread DN25 - R1"
socket flange DN32
brass design
stainless steel design
TV-approval 0000021402
contact for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
protection class IP 67
apaque cover
INSTALLATION RECOMMENDATIONS
Male thread design
DN40-65
tube DIN 2448 standard wall thickness
DN80-200
ACCESSORIES
The socket flanges as indicated in the installation recommendations
are available in the Honsberg accessory range
See product information 71.1 FL.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
145
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest CM2K-025HM/HK
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
3.1.
CM2K.
CM2K-025HM
TECHNICAL DATA
PN
bar
DN
Qmax. recom.
m/h H2O
3.6
25
25
6
32
25
9
25
40
15
25
50
24
25
65
36
25
80
60
25
100
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
weight
adjustable range
m/h H2O
paddle 1
0.9 - 1.0
2.3 - 2.7
2.8 - 3.4
6.5 - 7.5
11.4 - 13.3
16.5 - 18.9
26.3 - 30.3
paddle 1,2
1.9 - 2.4
4.8 - 5.7
7.6 - 8.9
13.3 - 15.3
paddle 1,2,3
2.7 - 3.5
6.7 - 8.4
paddle 1,2,3,4
5.4 - 6.7
15 % of full scale
max. 110C
0.15 bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 5 l/min.
0.35kg
MATERIALS
housing
paddle
bellow
protection
spring
magnet
CM2K-025HM
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel
1.4301 ;1.4571
NBR
POM
stainless steel 1.4310
oxyd 300
CM2K-025HK
stainless steel
1.4571
stainless steel
1.4301 ; 1,4571
NBR
POM
stainless steel 1.4310
oxyd 300
146
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest CM2K-025HM/HK
paddle
ELECTRICAL DATA
wiring 0.342
MOUNTING POSITION
QBASIC
Programme
options
3.1.
CM2K.
diode red
wiring 0.208
diode red/green
wiring 0.347
green
red
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
CM2K-
025
025
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
H M
H
M
K
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
basic type
specification
connection thread DN25 - R1"
socket thread
brass design
stainless steel design
wiring 0.208 - diode red integrated in plug DIN 43650-A
wiring 0.347 - diode red/green integrated in plug DIN 43650-A
wiring 0.342
gold-plated micro switch 125 V AC / 30 V DC / 100mA
setting / adjustable ranges for oil
contact for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
147
Basic
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
Fluvatest CRG-025HM/HK
3.1.
CRG.
CRG-025HM
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
Qmax. recom.
m/h H2O
adjustable range
m/h H2O
3.6
0.6 - 2.0
6
0.8 - 2.8
9
1.1 - 3.7
15
2.2 - 5.7
24
2.7 - 6.5
36
4.3 - 10.7
60
11.4 - 27.7
60
6.1 - 17.3
120
150
35.9 - 81.7
120
12.3 - 30.6
240
72.6 - 165.7
200
240
38.6 - 90.8
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
25
32
40
50
65
80
100
pressure
CRG-025HM
CRG-025HK
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
weight
adjustable range
reduced
m/h H2O
paddle
0.2 - 1.0
0.25- 1.4
0.5 - 1.9
0.9 - 3.6
1.2 - 4.9
2.1 - 7.4
4.9 - 17.1
3.3 - 11.6
16.6 - 47.6
6.1 - 21.4
25.7 - 90.1
21.7 - 55.3
1
1
1
1,2
1,2
1,2,3
1,2,3
1,2,3,4
1,2,3
1,2,3,4
1,2,3
1,2,3,4
11 bar static
11 bar dynamic
30 bar static
11 bar dynamic
max. 120C
0.08bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 0.1 l/min.
CRG-025HM
0.90kg
CRG-025HK
0.95kg
MATERIALS
housing
paddle
bellow
cap
CRE-025HM
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4571
tombak
ABS
CRE-025HK
stainless steel 1.4571
stainless steel 1.4571
stainless steel 1.4571
ABS
148
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest CRG-025HM/HK
paddle
3.1.
CRG.
ELECTRICAL DATA
white
MOUNTING POSITION
red
blue
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
CRG-
025
025
Special option
VARIO
H M S
H
M
K
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
0
basic type
specification
connection thread DN25 - R1"
socket thread
brass design
stainless steel design
cable gland in cap
reduced adjustable range
gold contacts 125 V AC / 1 A
adjustment
INSTALLATION RECOMMENDATIONS
SPECIAL APPLICATIONS
flow switch
TV-approval
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
149
Basic
Flow Switch
Fluvatest VM-...EM/EK
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
3.1.
VM.E
VM-050EM300
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
40
50
VM-040E.150
16
250
VM-050E.150
16
450
VM-050E.300
16
450
65
VM-065E.300
16
550
VM-065E.375
16
550
16
900
80
VM-080E.450
VM-080E.600
16
900
100
1400
16
VM-100E.750
16
1400
VM-100E.900
VM-150E.1500
2700
150
16
VM-150E.1800
16
2700
5400
200
VM-200E.3000
16
VM-200E.3600
5400
16
Adjustable range is indicated for horizontally decreasing flow.
Calibrated in tube DIN2448 standard wall thickness, socket height 50mm.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
adjustable range
l/min H2O
paddleform
L
approx
mm
weight
kg
40 - 150
50 - 150
100 - 300
100 - 300
125 - 375
150 - 450
200 - 600
250 - 750
300 - 900
500 - 1500
600 - 1800
1000 - 3000
1200 - 3600
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
93
104
96
115
90
118
115
158
122
198
198
213
213
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.5
3.5
5% of full scale
max. 90C
0.1bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 5 l/min.
MATERIALS
flange
body
paddle
components
spring
magnet
seal
VM-...EM
bronze Rg5
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4305 ;
1.4301
up to DN 80 stainless steel 1.4571
from DN100 brass Ms58
stainless steel
1.4310
oxyd 300
NBR
VM-...EK
stainless steel
1.4310
oxyd 300
viton
150
Basic
paddle
Flow Switch
Fluvatest VM-...EM/EK
3.1.
VM.E
ELECTRICAL DATA
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
040
050
065
080
100
150
200
E M
M
K
150
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
150
300
375
450
600
750
900
1500
1800
3000
3600
nominal diameter
of pipe
040
adjustable range
H2O horizontal
VM-
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
protection class IP 65
nominal diameter DN 250-500
gold-plated micro switch
signal lamp
special flanges
temperature up to 250C (stainless steel) / up to 200C (brass) type VMX
INSTALLATION RECOMMENDATIONS
tube Din 2448
standard
wall thickness
DN40-65
ACCESSORIES
The socket flanges as indicated in the installation recommendations
are available in the Honsberg accessory range
See product information 71.1 FL.
DN80-200
All technical changes reserved
YBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
151
Basic
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Novatron TZ1-...EM/EK
3.2.
TZ1.E
local metering
low pressure loss
easy adjustment by indicating pointer
TZ1-050EM300
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
40
TZ1-040E.250
16
450
TZ1-040E.350
16
450
TZ1-050E.350
16
50
450
16
TZ1-050E.450
450
65
TZ1-065E.350
16
550
TZ1-065E.500
16
550
80
900
16
TZ1-080E.450
16
900
TZ1-080E.600
16
100
TZ1-100E.800
1400
TZ1-100E.1050
16
1400
Metering range is indicated for horizontally increasing flow.
Calibrated in tube DIN2448 standard wall thickness, socket height 50mm.
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
hysteresis
metering range
l/min H2O
paddleform
L
approx
mm
weight
kg
50 - 250
100 - 350
80 - 350
100 - 450
100 - 350
150 - 500
130 - 450
200 - 600
300 - 800
350 - 1050
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
93
87
98
98
111
101
126
112
158
148
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
5% of full scale
max. 90C
0.1bar at Qmax.
depending on switch value
minimum 5 l/min.
MATERIALS
flange
body
paddle
components
spring
magnet
seal
VM-...EM
bronze Rg5
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4305 ;
1.4301
up to DN 80 stainless steel 1.4571
from DN100 brass Ms58
stainless steel
1.4310
oxyd 300
NBR
VM-...EK
stainless steel
1.4310
oxyd 300
viton
152
Basic
paddle
Flowmeter
Novatron TZ1-...EM/EK
3.2.
TZ1.E
ELECTRICAL DATA
Q BASIC Programme option
Y BASIC Standard
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
040
050
065
080
100
E M
Programme option
BASIC
M
K
250
250
350
450
500
600
800
1050
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
nominal
diameter of
pipe
TZ1TZ1M-
040
metering range
H2O horizontal
TZ1-
Special option
VARIO
basic type
specification
Flowmeter
Flowmeter with integrated micro switch
DN 40
DN 50
DN 65
DN 80
DN 100
socket flange
brass design
stainless steel design
50 - 250 l/min
(80) 100 - 350 l/min
(100) 130 - 450 l/min
150 - 500 l/min
200 - 600 l/min
300 - 800 l/min
350 - 1050 l/min
front switch unit with 10-kOhm-potentiometer
diode
nominal diameter DN 125-500
special ranges
metering range for oil
front switch unit 2pol, n.o. or n.c.
INSTALLATION RECOMMENDATIONS
ACCESSORIES
The socket flanges as indicated in the installation recommendations
are available in the Honsberg accessory range
See product information 71.1 FL.
DN40-65
DN80-200
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
153
Basic
Flowmeter
Fluvatest UZ-...GM/GK
paddle
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
3.2.
UZ.G
local metering
low pressure loss
good repeatability
dirt-resistant
easy adjustment by indicating pointer
TECHNICAL DATA
UZ-025GM100
Type
Qmax.
recom.
l/min H2O
metering range
l/min H2O ; 1bar abs
left
H
mm
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
201
206
201
209
215
227
201
206
201
209
215
227
70
74
87
104
111
130
70
74
87
104
111
130
30
36
46
55
65
70
30
36
46
55
65
70
16
18
19
22
24
28
16
18
19
22
24
28
2.0
2.0
2.5
3.0
4.5
5.0
2.0
2.0
2.5
3.0
4.5
5.0
flow from
right (optional)
stainless steel
brass
60
UZ-015GM...
3 - 50
G 1/2
100
UZ-020GM...
4 - 60
G 3/4
UZ-025GM...
200
10 - 100
4 - 60
G1
UZ-032GM...
300
G 1 1/4
20 - 200
10 - 100
UZ-040GM...
400
G 1 1/2
20 - 200
10 - 300
G2
UZ-050GM...
600
20 - 300
30 - 500
UZ-015GK...
60
G 1/2
3 - 50
UZ-020GK...
G 3/4
100
4 - 60
4 - 60
10 - 100
200
G1
UZ-025GK...
G 1 1/4
UZ-032GK...
10 - 100
20 - 200
300
400
G 1 1/2
UZ-040GK...
20 - 200
10 - 300
600
UZ-050GK...
20 - 300
30 - 500
G2
Metering range is indicated for horizontally increasing flow.
Please notice the pressure-dependend deviation of the indication range.
2 - 35
4 - 45
6 - 70
4 - 50
10 - 100
10 - 100
20 - 200
20 - 200
10 - 300
60 - 300
100 - 500
2 - 35
6 - 70
4 - 45
4 - 50
10 - 100
10 - 100
20 - 200
20 - 200
10 - 300
100 - 500
60 - 300
Q(% )
100
80
60
40
tolerance
pressure range
media temperature
average pressure loss
10 bar
3% of full scale
16 bar static
6 bar dynamic
max. 100C
0.2 bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
housing
paddle
bellow
UZ-...GM
brass Ms58
nickel plated
stainless steel 1.4571 ;
1.4305
stainless steel 1.4571
UZ-...GK
154
Basic
paddle
Flowmeter
Fluvatest UZ-...GM/GK
3.2.
UZ.G
ELECTRICAL DATA
Y BASIC Standard
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
015
020
025
032
040
050
G M
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
M
K
035
035
045
050
060
070
100
200
300
500
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Q
Y
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
0
nominal
diameter
015
metering range
H2O horizontal
UZUZUZM-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
155
Basic
paddle
Flowmeter
Fluvatest UZ-...GM/GK
3.2.
UZ.G
OPTION
Q UZM- integrated micro switch
wiring 0.342 change over
250 V AC 5 A
plug DIN 43650-A
protection class IP 65
1.switch
2.switch
1.switch
2.switch
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
156
Basic
dynamic flap
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
3.5.
XF.1
XF-020GMI080S
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
range
l/min H2O
L
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
G 3/4
XF-008GM.
XF-010GM.
XF-015GM.
XF-020GM.
16
16
16
16
1 - 15 l/min
1 - 25 l/min
1 - 50 l/min
1 - 80 l/min
74
74
78
82
12
12
14
16
0.60
0.60
0.60
0.65
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
3% of measured value
minimum 0.25 l/min
0..70C
0.5 bar at top of range
Since the shutter functions only through bending without a rotary bearing,
there are no friction effects and thus a very small hysteresis and good
reproducibility of the measurement results or switching point. The low mass
and evaluation of the entire flow cross-section are responsible for the fast
response time and unproblematic pipeline routing.
Flow
The
extremely
bendable
shutter is flush with a stop and
can
thus
never
be
overstretched
by
water
impacts.
OPERATION
It has to be observed, that the sensor is installed in the direction of the flow
arrow. Despite its low mass, the shutter is very robust. In case of
disassembly or mounting, however, it still should not be forcibly bent or
compressed.
The housing screws go through the entire housing and have to be removed
completely when the sensor head is exchanged. After that, the body, as
usual in the case of a flange part, can be removed without loosening the
screw connection. If return flows occur, please ask about alternatives!
MATERIAL
housing
connection
flap
flap fastener
indicator
sealing
PPS
brass nickel plated
s.s. 1.4031k
PVDF
cobalt samarium
viton
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
157
Basic
dynamic flap
ELECTRICAL DATA
supply voltage
connection
short-circuit proof
reverse polarity proof
protection class
10..30 V DC
for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
yes
yes
IP 67
NPN
1
brow n
4
3
2
black
blue
w hite
MOUNTING POSITION
+
output
0V
programming
water
XF-
008 G M R 015 S
008
010
015
020
G
A
M
K
P
U
I
F
S
E
R
P
N
015
025
050
080
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Y
Q
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Q
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 8
nominal diameter DN 10
nominal diameter DN 15
nominal diameter DN 20
female thread
male thread
connection material brass
connection material stainless steel
connection material POM
voltage output 0..10V
current output 4..20mA
frequency output
programmable switch (push-pull = PNP and NPN)
output at suburb electronics (e.g. omni-XF)
reed switch change over (on request)
proximity switch PNP n.o. (on request)
proximity switch NPN n.o. (on request)
range 1 - 15 l/min
range 1 - 25 l/min
range 1 - 50 l/min
range 1 - 80 l/min
connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
COMBINATIONS
omni-XF
local electronic unit,
2x push-pull-switch
4(0)..20mA output
graphical LCD display with flashing LED
program ring
Flex-XF
switching and frequency output
0..10V or 4..20mA
pnp, npn
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
158
XF.1
100 mA
current 4..20 mA
voltage 0..10V
frequency output / programmable switch
idle current
< 20 mA (without load)
output
push-pull (PNP and NPN)
10..2000 Hz
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
3.5.
Why to use a
Basic
paddle instrument
versatility in installation
and liquid selection
l Magnetic link
without mechanical
interference
Where to use a
Basic
paddle instrument
Market segments
l Boilers
l Transformers
l Swimming pools
l Pumps
l Burners
l Engine
l High transportation
speed
Application
l Command of the diverter valve in combi boilers
l Alarm in transformers in case of missing oil lubrication
l Control of chemical additives in commercial pools
l Shut off burners in case of water failure
160
Turbine
The medium drives the turbine in a housing.
A down-flow Hall sensor detects the ferromagnetic blades of the turbine. The flow speed is
proportional to the detected frequency.
Gear wheel
The medium fills the defined space between
the gear wheels and turns the toothed wheels
depending on the volume flow. A down-flow
Hall sensor detects one pulse per gear wheel
volume space transported. The volume is
proportional to the detected frequency.
Oval wheel
The medium fills the defined space between
the oval wheels and turns the toothed wheels
depending on the volume flow. An inductive
sensor detects one pulse per gear wheel
volume space transported. The volume is
proportional to the detected frequency.
Contents
System description
Device systems
162
Output signals
163
163
164
164
Device descriptions
165
Application
l Use as flow transmitter for liquid metering materials and viscous
media in industrial applications
l Visual flow control of liquids and gases
Advantages
l Simple, reliable structure
l Pulse transmission
Technical data
Concept
Nominal diameter
Connection
PN
Max. temperature
Signal
Adjustable
Materials
Enstallation position
Metering materials
Housing or probe
6 - 150
female thread, hose nozzle or stub-connection
6 - 250
100 C
frequency, current, voltage
l Switching
l Indicating
l Metering
161
Basic
System description
Device systems
The Honsberg device systems rotor, turbine, gear wheel and oval wheel
are used for flow indication and continuous flow metering. The primary
component is the rotor or turbine, gear wheel or oval wheel situated
in the liquid chamber. What these primary elements have in common is
that the medium which enters the space causes the element to revolve
directly proportionally to the flow rate, thus allowing visual indication of
the flow rate via the revolution or producing a linear output signal
dependent on the flow by activating sensors.
Appropriately integrated circuits used in place of basic sensors produce
frequency modulating signals, switching signals or 4..20 mA outputs.
Accuracy
Liquids
Gases
Viscosity
compensated
Ranges l/min
Max. Temperature C
Rotor
Turbine
Gear wheel Oval wheel
3%
1%
3%
2.5%
Measured value Final value Measured value Final value
+
+
+
+
optional
optional
up to
up to
+
+
10 mm 2/s 15 mm 2/s
0.1-1000
100
0.1-1130
90
0.02-1501
120
0.3-40
60
Rotor
The rotor is a rotary element positioned frontally arranged with positive
locking on a bearing-supported axis. It is set in rotary motion by the
flow.
Turbine
The turbine is a rotary element with linear blade orientation to flow
direction and rotate proportionally to the flow around an axis positioned
in flow direction.
Gear wheel
A metal pair of gear wheels rotates around a metal axis in a metal
housing. Viscosity stability is given thanks due to volumetric operation.
Oval wheel
A plastic pair of oval wheels rotates around a metal axis. Viscosity
stability is given due to volumetric operation.
162
Output signals
Display
The medium enters the device housing and causes the visible rotor
to rotate. The revolution frequency can be used to make an indicative
statement about the current flow rate. Some of the primary components are bedded friction-free in high-quality plastic bearings and are
also used for gases if the shaft is arranged into mini ball bearings.
Sensors
WR 1
Inductive
+
-
Hall
+
Optical
+
+
-
E
Inductive
A rotor/turbine/oval wheel with metal fittings is bedded via a ceramic
axis in ceramic bearings. The revolutions are picked up by the external
inductive sensor and thus produce a linear frequency signal which corresponds to the flow rate.
Rotor
Turbine
Oval wheel
Rotor
Rotor
Turbine
Hall
This is a magnetically triggered sensor which can be used in cases
when a metal housing has to be used on account of the existing
pressure conditions. For this purpose the rotor/turbine/gear
wheel/oval wheel are fitted with magnets which trigger the Hall sensor.
Optical
When an optical sensor is used, the rotation frequency of the rotor blades is detected without further triggering elements being necessary. On
account of the material choice, these devices are usually used for problematic metering material environments.
Oval wheel
RO
RRI-032
DN 65
163
Basic
Viscosity
1 mm2/s
115 mm2/s
Flow rate
5.0 l/min
5.0 l/min
no deviation
VHZ group
Primary sensors
Heads
External
transducers
164
rotor
turbine
FR
16
100
167
RM
16
100
168
WR1
16
16
100
100
l
l
3
3
169
control
RA
l
l
10
10
55
55
l
l
3
3
170
RH
l
l
10
5
80
80
l
l
3
3
172
16
60
174
l
l
3
3
176
l
l
l
l
3
3
3
3
3
RRI
m m l m
RRH
m m l m
m m l m
RRO
m m l m
RR.-32
m
m
m
m
l
l
l
l
HV
RO
5 - 15 nozzle plastic
100 100
100 100
16
60
10 60
10 60
10 60
100 100
6
l
178
180
10
100
85
14
100
185
183
filter
184
RRF
RRT
m
m
l
l
m
m
10
100
90
90
l
l
3
3
187
RRT1
m
m
l
l
m
m
10
100
90
90
l
l
3
3
250
85
m
l
m
l
m m l
l
m
m
m
m
m
200
200
200
100
85
85
85
85
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
192
m l
10
60
196
RT
l standard
l
l
page
oil
166
miscellaneous
water
aggressive
max. temperature C
gas/air
60
on site metering
16
output signal
indication
nominal diameter
connection
type
PO
VHZ
VHO
8
10
20
25
female
female
female
female
thread
thread
thread
thread
Al/stainless
Al/stainless
Al/stainless
Al/stainless
m standard option
special option
steel
steel
steel
steel
190
165
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow PO-...GVA
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.1.
PO.
PO-010GVA
Questra
TECHNICAL DATA
L
L1
B
H
C
E SW X
mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
range
l/min H2O
G 3/8
G 3/8
G 3/8
G1
G1
G1
PO-010GVA020
PO-010GVA050
PO-010GVA070
PO-025GVA080
PO-025GVA120
PO-025GVA160
16
16
16
16
16
16
1.5
10
12
30
60
100
0,1 - 1,5
0,2 - 10
0,4 - 12
50
50
84
29
2
3
4
70
70
110
53
media temperature
- 30
- 60
- 100
weight
kg
12,5 16,5
22
12
0.1
27,5
38
18
0.4
23
max. 60C
MATERIALS
DN 10
PPS (Fortron 1140L4)
PSU Ultrason
PVDF
ceramic
iglidur X
viton
body
cover
rotor
axle
bearings
seal
MOUNTING POSITION
DN 25
Questra
PC transparent
PVDF
ceramic
iglidur X
viton
NOMENCLATURE
PO- 010 G V
010
025
A 020
[
[
[
[
S
V
M
METERING SUBSTANCES
020
050
070
080
120
160
Wasser
[
[
[
[
[
[
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 10 - G3/8
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
female thread
connection material PVDF
connection material brass
housing material
Questra / PPS with
transparent cover
flow diameter 2
flow diameter 5
flow diameter 7
flow diameter 8
flow diameter 12
flow diameter 16
l
With higher viscosity
instruments tend to higher
starting values for rotor.
All technical changes reserved
[BASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
166
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow FR-...GR
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.1.
FR.
FR-015GR
bronze
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
start of rotor
l/min H2O
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
L
mm
B
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
FR-015GR
FR-020GR
FR-025GR
16
16
16
2.5
3.0
25
45
65
85
85
95
68
68
74
36
36
42
14
14
16
1.20
1.10
1.25
media temperature
average pressue loss
5.0
max. 100C
0.09 bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
body
ring
window
bolt
rotor
seal
bronze Rg5
brass Ms58
soda-lime natural glass
stainless steel 1.4305
POM
klingersil C4400
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
FR-
015
G R
015
020
025
[
[
[
[
[
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 20 - G3/4
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
female thread
bronze
SPECIAL DESIGNS
METERING SUBSTANCES
type RS-...GR
female thread G1/4 bis G2
rotor brass
housing bronze
water
oil
type RS-...FG
flange DN 25 to 80
rotor brass
housing cast iron
RS-040FG
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
167
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow RM-...GR
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.1.
RM.
RM-015GK
bronze / s.s.
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
start of rotor
l/min H2O
pressure loss
at Qmax.
L
mm
H
mm
SW
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
RM-008G.
RM-010G.
RM-015G.
RM-020G.
RM-025G.
16
16
16
16
16
8
10
20
40
60
0.7
0.8
1.0
1.2
1.5
0.20
0.15
0.40
0.25
0.70
76
76
76
89
89
53
53
53
66
66
28
28
28
45
45
12
16
14
18
18
0.70
0.65
0.65
1.25
1.20
media temperature
max. 100C
MATERIALS
MOUNTING POSITION
RM-GK
stainless steel
stainless steel
borosilikate
stainless steel
PPS
Klingersil C-4400
NOMENCLATURE
RM-
008
G R
008
010
015
020
025
METERING SUBSTANCES
R
K
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
nominal
diameter
RM-GR
bronze
brass
borosilikate
stainless steel
PPS
Klingersil C-4400
body
ring
dome
shaft
rotor
seal
basic type
specification
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
bronze
stainless steel
water
oil
With higher viscosity
instruments tend to higher
starting values for rotor.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
168
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow WR1-...GM/GK
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.1.
WR1.
TECHNICAL DATA
WR1-015GK
Type
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
G 1 1/4
G 1 1/2
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
WR1-008G.
WR1-010G.
WR1-015G.
WR1-020G.
WR1-025G.
WR1-032G.
WR1-040G.
pressure
media temperature
average pressure loss
4
8
12
25
40
80
100
40 mm/s
41-150 mm/s
0.7
0.8
1.4
1.4
1.7
8.0
8.0
1.5
1.5
1.8
2.7
3.0
5.9
7.3
2.7
2.8
3.2
5.9
7.0
7.9
7.9
L
mm
SW
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
71
71
86
94
104
120
130
36
36
46
46
46
65
65
9
9
13
16
16
19
20
0.35
0.35
0.65
0.65
0.65
1.60
1.70
PN 16
max. 100C
0.25 bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
brass Ms58 nickel plat.
DN 8-25 POM red
DN 32-40 nylon white
borosilicate glass
stainless steel 1.4541
PEEK
NBR
NBR
tube
axle
bearing
wiper
seal
WR1-...GK
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
WR1-
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air only
special option
with ball bearing
oil
With higher viscosity instruments
tend to higher starting values of the rotor.
008
G M W
008
010
015
020
025
032
040
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
M
K
W
G
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
0
S
0
nominal diameter
WR1-...GM
housing
rotor
basic type
specification
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
DN 32 - G1 1/4
DN 40 - G1 1/2
female thread
brass design
stainless steel design
liquids
air/gasses
seal / wiper EPDM
low flow rates
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
169
Basic
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
The instruments are used for liquids while a rotor in fullplastic housing generates flow-dependent revolutions
which are detected optically.
Flowmeter
Rototron RA
4.2.
RA.
compact dimension
progammable limits
control of small flow rates
max. viscosity 10mm/s
magnet isolated
signal output 4..20 mA
RA-008AP100
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
G 1/4A RA-008AP100
POM
ECTFE (Halar) G 1/4A RA-008AH100
tolerance
repeatability
media temperature
PN
Qmax. recom.
l/h H2O
metering range
l/h H2O
pulse/ litre
frequency
Hz of full scale
weight
g
10
10
100
100
1.5 - 100
1.5 - 100
8400
8400
233
233
100
100
2%
<0.8%
-10.. +55 C
PRESSURE LOSS
10000
1000
100
10
pressure
loss
mbar
1
10
100
1000
flow rate l/h
MATERIALS
body
rotor
bearings
axle
magnet
seal
RA-...AP
POM
POM
POM
nivapoint
hardferrite
viton
RA-...AH
ECTFE (halar)
ECTFE (halar)
rubin
saphir
cobald-somarium
viton
170
Basic
rotor
Flowmeter
Rototron RA
ELECTRICAL DATA
4.2.
RA.
2 - brow n
inductive
supply: 24 VDC
exit signal: 4..20mA
cable 3x0,14 Liyy - 1m
cable allocation arbitrary
Sensor
MOUNTING POSITION
1 + w hite
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil up to 10mm/s
NOMENCLATURE
RA-
008
008
A P
A
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
P
H
[
[
[
[
[
S
basic type
specification
DN 8 - G1/4A
male thread
POM
halar
metering range 1.5 - 100
seal NBR, EPDM
seal Kalrez
100
100
PROGRAMMING
The integrated micro controller computes each flow between the two measuring limit values 4mA and 20mA. For this, each measuring limit
value must assigned (programmed) a flow. The following operational sequence describes this procedure:
1.) Adjust the desired flow for the 4mA measuring border.
2.) Operate briefly the reed switch (hold briefly the magnet pin to the reed switch ).
(red LED shines and orange LED is out)
3.) after an firmly adjusted time the red LED shines and the orange LED flashes with about 4Hz. Now
adjust the desired flow for the 20mA measuring border.
4.) Operate briefly the reed switch again (hold briefly the magnet pin to the reed switch ).
(red LED shines and orange LED is out)
5.) after an firmly adjusted time the red and orange LED do not shine any longer. The micro controller
check and save the adjusted worth. Afterwards the program starts with the new worth.
INDICATE
The yellow LED is shining in the operation. The brightness is dependent on the output current.
If the both measuring limit values are zero, then the two LEDs (red and orange) flash with about 4Hz.
If the flow is lower as the calibrated flow for the 4mA-border, then the orange LED flash with about 8Hz and the red LED is out.
During the normal enterprise (flow between the two limit values) shines the orange LED and the red LED is out.
If the flow is higher as the calibrated flow for the 20mA-border, then the orange LED flash with about 4Hz and the red LED is out.
The red LED shines only during the Programming modus (see also Programming of the two measuring borders).
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
171
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RH
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.2.
RH.
The instruments are used for liquids while a rotor in fullplastic housing generates flow-dependent revolutions
which are detected optically.
compact dimension
control of small flow rates
max. viscosity 10mm/s
magnet isolated
RH-006TP100
TECHNICAL DATA
G
POM
POM
Type
Nozzle 6 RH-006TP100
G 1/4A
RH-008AP100
RH-008AP250
tolerance
repeatability
media temperature
PN
Qmax. recom.
l/h H2O
metering range
l/h H2O
pulse/ litre
frequency
Hz of full scale
weight
g
5
10
100
100
250
1.5 - 100
1.5 - 100
6.0 - 250
8400
8400
3400
233
233
236
50
50
50
2%
<0.8%
-10..+80 C
LINEARITY
10
9
8
7
6
5 a
4
3
b
x1000 2
pulse/l
1
5 10
a= 1,5-100l/h
b= 6-250 l/h
50 100
500 1000
flow rate l/h
PRESSURE LOSS
10000
1000
100
10
pressure
loss
mbar
1
5 10
a= 1,5-100l/h
b= 6-250 l/h
100
1000
flow rate l/h
MATERIALS
body
rotor
bearings
axle
magnet
seal
POM
POM
POM
nivapoint
hardferrite
viton
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
172
Basic
rotor
Flowmeter
Rototron RH
ELECTRICAL DATA
4.2.
RH.
2
Sensor
MOUNTING POSITION
- brow n
green
+ w hite
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil up to 10mm/s
NOMENCLATURE
RH-
006
006
008
T
T
A
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
basic type
specification
DN 6 - nozzle 6
DN 8 - G1/4A
nozzle
male thread
POM
metering range 1.5 - 100
metering range 6.0 - 250
seal NBR, EPDM
seal Kalrez
100
100
250
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
173
Basic
flowmeter
Rototron RRI
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.2.
RRI.
RRI-025GVQ
RRI-010GVQ
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax.
recom.
l/min H2O
metering range
l/min H2O
(1)
(2)
pulse/ litre
frequency
Hz of full
scale
(6)
(10)
(3)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(7)
pulse / litre
(9)
(8)
255
558
351
608
607
420
10200
3345
1755
1216
607
252
DN25
DN10
1.8
0.1- 1.5
0.5- 1.5
0.1-0.5
16
RRI-010...020
12
0.2-10
2.0-10
0.2-2
16
RRI-010...050
0.4-2
16.8
0.4-12
2.0-12
16
RRI-010...070
36
2- 30
3- 30
2- 3
RRI-025...080
G1
16
72
3- 60
5- 60
3- 5
RRI-025...120
16
120
4-100
6-100
4- 6
RRI-025...160
16
The measurements were taken from left to right with the sensor stationary using water at 25C.
G3/8
weight
kg
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.55
0.55
0.55
(9)
Hz
(8)
(6) (5)
l / min
(3)
(1)
(2)
l / min
(3)
(4)
(1)
(2)
(4)
rotor
bearings
axle
seal
no medium contact
Questra /
PPS (Fortron 1140L4)
PVDF / 1.4310
Iglidur X
ceramic Zr02-TZP
viton
PVC cable
1.4305, 1.4301
DN25
housing
DN10
MATERIALS
Type
G3/8
RRI-010G
RRI-010A
RRI-010T
RRI-025G
RRI-025A
RRI-025T
G1
F * SW X
C
B
D
E
L
L1
H
mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm
50
50
50
70
70
70
50
50
50
70
70
70
84
84
96
110
122
176
29
29
29
53
53
53
12,5
12,5
12,5
23
23
23
11
30
16,5
16,5
16,5
27,5
27,5
27,5
22
22
38
38
38
12
14
21
18
18
45
174
38
38
38
33
33
33
Basic
flowmeter
Rototron RRI
rotor
ELECTRICAL DATA
P NP
MOUNTING POSITION
1
4
3
NPN
1
4
3
+ 5 ..3 0 V DC
b l a ck
b ro wn
blue
b rown
si g n a l
z
b l a ck
RRI.
NAM UR
b ro wn
blue
4.2.
b l ue
0 V
+ 7 ..1 2 VDC
0 V
+ 5 ..3 0 V DC
z
sig n a l
0 V
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil up to 10mm/s
NOMENCLATURE
basic type
specification
[ DN 010
010
[ DN 025
025
[ female thread
G
S male thread
A
S hose nozzle
T
[ connection material PVDF
V
S connection material brass Ms58 nickel plated
M
S connection material stainless steel 1.4305
K
[ housing material Questra/PPS
Q
[ housing material PVDF
V
DN 10 housing material PPS with transparent cover PSU
S
A
DN 25 housing material Questra with transparent cover PC
[ flow diameter 2
020
[ flow diameter 5
050
[ flow diameter 7
070
[ flow diameter 8
080
[ flow diameter 12
120
[ flow diameter 16
160
[ seal viton
V
S seal EPDM
E
S seal NBR
N
[ rotor with 10 clamp
10
S rotor with 2 clamp
02
S rotor with 5 clamp
05
[ clamp materal stainless steal 1.4310
K
S clamp materal titanium
T
[ PNP output
P
[ NPN output
N
S Namur output
A
[ ouput at suburb electronics (e.g. omni-RR)
E
K [ 2 m cable
S S connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
special applications: Switching output, frequency converter, current output and omni/flex processor
RRI-
010 G V Q 020 V 10 K P
COMBINATIONS
omni-RR
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)..20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
further transformers
Flex
switching and frequency exit, 0..10V or 4..20mA, pnp, npn
ESA1
electronic monitoring unit
ESK2
2 switchpoints - supply 24 V DC
ESK3
1 switchpoint - supply 230 V AC
conceived for safety-relevant applications
EFFS
switch output
EFFI
current output 4(0)..20mA
EFFF
frequency output
All technical changes reserved
[BASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
175
Basic
flowmeter
Rototron RRH
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.2.
RRH.
RRH-025GMM
RRH-010GMM
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
metering range
l/min H2O
Qmax.
recom.
l/min H2O
(1)
(2)
pulse/ litre
frequency
Hz of full
scale
(6)
(10)
(3)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(7)
pulse / litre
0.60
0.60
0.60
1.90
1.90
1.90
(9)
Hz
(9)
(8)
124
272
172
272
295
210
4955
1632
860
544
295
126
DN25
DN10
1.8
0.1- 1.5
0.5- 1.5
0.1-0.5
RRH-010...020
100
12
0.2-10
2.0-10
0.2-2
RRH-010...050
100
16.8
0.4-12
2.0-12
0.4-2
RRH-010...070
100
36
2- 30
2- 3
3- 30
RRH-025...080
G1
100
72
3- 60
5- 60
3- 5
RRH-025...120
100
4- 6
120
4-100
6-100
RRH-025...160
100
The measurements were taken from left to right with the sensor stationary using water at 25C.
G3/8
weight
kg
(8)
(6) (5)
l / min
(3)
(1)
(2)
(4)
l / min
(3)
(1)
(2)
(4)
MATERIALS
housing
rotor
bearings
axle
seal
no medium contact
DN G
Ms58 nickel plat. or 1.4305
PVDF with magnet
Iglidur X
ceramic Zr02-TZP
viton
PVC cable
1.4305, 1.4301
10
G3/8
25
G1
Type
RRH-010G
RRH-010A
RRH-025G
RRH-025A
F * SW X
B
E
C
H
L
L1
mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm
50
50
70
70
50
50
70
70
84
84
110
122
12
29 12,5 16,5 38
22
14
29 12,5 16,5 38
22
38
18
53
23 27,5 33
53
23 27,5 33
38
18
* dimension F at Namur 8 mm cancel!
176
Basic
flowmeter
Rototron RRH
rotor
ELECTRICAL DATA
P NP
30mA
100mA
2m cable or conection at
locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
ja
ja
IP67
MOUNTING POSITION
1
4
3
NPN
1
4
3
+ 1 0 ..3 0 V DC
b l a ck
blue
b ro wn
si g n a l
z
brown
black
RRH.
NAM UR
b ro wn
blue
4.2.
blue
0 V
+ 7 ..1 2 VDC
0 V
+ 10..30 V DC
z
A usgangssignal
0 V
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil up to 10mm/s
NOMENCLATURE
basic type
specification
[ DN 010
010
[ DN 025
025
[ female thread
G
S male thread
A
[ connection material brass Ms58 nickel plated
M
[ connection material stainless steel 1.4305
K
[ housing material brass Ms58 nickel plated
M
[ housing material stainless steel 1.4305
K
[ flow diameter 2
020
[ flow diameter 5
050
[ flow diameter 7
070
[ flow diameter 8
080
[ flow diameter 12
120
[ flow diameter 16
160
[ seal viton
V
S seal EPDM
E
S seal NBR
N
3 seal Kemraz
K
[ rotor with 5 magnet
05
S rotor with 2 magnet
02
[ rotor material PVDF
V
[ PNP output
P
[ NPN output
N
S Namur output
A
[ ouput at suburb electronics (e.g. omni-RR)
E
K [ 2 m cable
S S connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
special applications: Switching output, frequency converter, current output and omni/flex processor
RRH-
010 G M M 020 V 05 V
COMBINATIONS
omni-RR
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)..20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
further transformers
Flex
switching and frequency exit, 0..10V or 4..20mA, pnp, npn
ESA1
electronic monitoring unit
ESK2
2 switchpoints - supply 24 V DC
ESK3
1 switchpoint - supply 230 V AC
conceived for safety-relevant
applications
EFFS
switch output
EFFI
current output 4(0)..20mA
EFFF
frequency output
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
177
Basic
flowmeter
Rototron RRO
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.2.
RRO.
RRO-025GVV
RRO-010GVV
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
metering range
l/min H2O
Qmax.
recom.
l/min H2O
(1)
(2)
pulse/ litre
frequency
Hz of full
scale
(6)
(10)
(3)
(7)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
pulse / litre
0.20
0.20
0.20
0.55
0.55
0.55
(9)
Hz
(9)
(8)
293
493
341
545
588
442
11720
2960
1703
1090
588
265
DN25
DN10
1.8
0.1- 1.5
0.5- 1.5
0.1-0.5
16
RRO-010...020
12
0.2-10
2.0-10
0.2-2
16
RRO-010...050
0.4-2
16.8
0.4-12
2.0-12
RRO-010...070
16
2- 3
3- 30
36
2- 30
RRO-025...080
G1
16
72
3- 60
5- 60
3- 5
RRO-025...120
16
120
4-100
6-100
4- 6
RRO-025...160
16
The measurements were taken from left to right with the sensor stationary using water at 25C.
G3/8
weight
kg
(8)
l / min
(3)
(1)
(2)
l / min
(3)
(4)
(1)
(2)
(4)
DN25
PVDF
PVDF
Iglidur X
ceramck Zr02-TZP
viton
PVC cable
1.4305, 1.4301
DN10
MATERIALS
housing
rotor
bearings
axle
seal
no medium contact
Type
G3/8
RRO-010G
RRO-010A
RRO-010T
RRO-025G
RRO-025A
RRO-025T
G1
H
L
L1
E
F * SW X
C
D
B
mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm mm
50
50
50
70
70
70
50
50
50
70
70
70
84
84
96
110
122
176
29
29
29
53
53
53
12,5
12,5
12,5
23
23
23
11
30
16,5
16,5
16,5
27,5
27,5
27,5
22
22
38
38
38
12
14
21
18
18
45
178
38
38
38
33
33
33
Basic
flowmeter
Rototron RRO
rotor
P NP
ELECTRICAL DATA
30mA
100mA
2m cable or conection at
locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
yes
yes
IP67
short-circuit proof
reverse polarity proof
protection class
MOUNTING POSITION
1
4
3
brown
NPN
1
4
3
sig nal
z
brown
bl ack
bl ue
RRO.
+ 24 V DC 10%
bl ack
bl ue
4.2.
0 V
+ 24 V DC 10%
z
si gnal
0 V
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
water
oil up to
10mm/s
aggressive liquids
basic type
specification
[ DN 010
010
[ DN 025
025
[ female thread
G
S male thread
A
S hose nozzle
T
[ connection material PVDF
V
S connection material brass Ms58 nickel plated
M
S connection material stainless steel 1.4305
K
[ housing material PVDF
V
[ flow diameter 2
020
[ flow diameter 5
050
[ flow diameter 7
070
[ flow diameter 8
080
[ flow diameter 12
120
[ flow diameter 16
160
[ seal viton
V
S seal EPDM
E
S seal NBR
N
3 seal Kemraz
K
[ PNP output
P
[ NPN output
N
[ ouput at suburb electronics (e.g. omni-RR)
E
K [ 2 m cable
S S connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
special applications: Switching output, frequency converter, current output and omni/flex processor
RRO-
010 G V
V 020 V
COMBINATIONS
omni-RR
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)..20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
further transformers
Flex
switching and frequency exit, 0..10V or 4..20mA, pnp, npn
ESA1
electronic monitoring unit
ESK2
2 switchpoints - supply 24 V DC
ESK3
1 switchpoint - supply 230 V AC
conceived for safety-relevant
applications
EFFS
switch output
EFFI
current output 4(0)..20mA
EFFF
frequency output
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
179
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RR.-032
rotor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
4.2.
RR32
RRI-032RMH000
RRI-032MHH065
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
Type
metering range
l/min H2O
Qmax.
recom.
l/min
(1)
(2)
frequency
Hz of full
scale
(6)
(10)
90
48
34
24
17,5
10,5
300
240
227
200
204
175
(3)
30 - 200
15 - 30
220
15 - 200
32
RR.-032MH032
360
15 - 300
15 - 60
60 - 300
40
RR.-032MH040
480
25 - 400
80 - 400
25 - 80
50
RR.-032MH050
600
40 - 500
100 - 500
40 - 100
65
RR.-032MH065
840
50 - 700
100 - 700
50 - 100
RR.-032MH080
80
1200
85 - 1000
100 - 1000
85 - 100
100
RR.-032MH100
The measurements were taken from left to right with the sensor stationary using water at 25C.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
pulse/ litre
(7)
pulse / litre
(8)
(9)
(6) (5)
l / min
(3)
(1)
(2)
(4)
(9)
Hz
(8)
l / min
(3)
(1)
(2)
MATERIALS
housing
assembly clamp
rotor
bearings
axle
seal
no medium contact
plastic PVC
plastic PP
PVDF / stainless steel 1.4310
Iglidur X
ceramic Zr02-TZP
viton
PVC cable
brass Ms58 nickel plated
180
(4)
weight
kg
0.8
0.8
0.9
1.2
1.3
1.4
Basic
rotor
Flowmeter
Rototron RR.-032
4.2.
RR32
DIMENSIONS
assembly clamp saddle with pipe and sleeve RR.-032MH
nominal
diameter
L1
L2
L3
DN 32
DN 40
DN 50
DN 65
DN 80
DN 100
DN 125
DN 150
40
50
63
75
90
110
140
160
1,9
2,4
3,0
3,6
4,3
5,3
6,7
7,7
145
145
145
154
156
166
172
180
132
142
156
178
202
232
287
312
31
36
43
49
56
66
81
91
55
65
79
92
107
128
159
180
26
31
38
44
51
61
76
86
E
nominal
diameter
DN 50
DN 65
DN 80
DN 100
DN 125
DN 150
63
75
90
110
140
160
70
80
90
100
125
130
145
164
156
166
172
180
customer
assembly welded pruning RR.-032RM
customer
customer
MOUNTING
The Flowmeters are mounted as probes in a T-piece or in a mounting clamp; and marked for the correct insertion depth. The sensor
mounting direction is longitudinally to the turbine wheel and is marked with arrows on the face of the probe. (With the electronics mounted,
the direction of flow is longitudinal to the electronics housing. A deviation of up to 3 in the angular orientation does not affect the
measurement. The sensor must be mounted with inlet and outlet sections of approx. 10 x the pipe diameter to avoid swirls and turbulence.
The best mounting orientation (low contamination, good venting) is for upward flow direction or horizontal pipe route and an inclined sensor
position of 45.
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
181
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RR.-032
rotor
RR32
PNP
ELECTRICAL DATA
supply voltage
quiescent current consumption
max. output current
sensor connection
short-circuit proof
reverse polarity proof
protection class
4.2.
MOUNTING POSITION
4
3
NPN
1
4
3
brown
black
signal
z
blue
brown
0V
+
z
black
blue
signal
0V
NAMUR
brown
blue
+
0 V
METERING SUBSTANCES
air bubbles!
water
sediment!
NOMENCLATURE
basic type
specification
[ Flowmeter with inductive sensor
RRI[ Flowmeter with hall sensor
RRH[ screwed cap G1 1/4
032
[ clamp saddle with pipe and sleeve at PVC
MH
[ screwed-in probe G1 1/4 with clamp ring and screwed cap
RM
S clamp saddle PP
BB
S welded pruning stainless steel 1.4305
VK
[ probe material PVC
H
[ probe material stainless steel 1.4305
K
[ (at screwed-in probe or welded pruning)
000
[ DN 032
032
[ DN 040
040
[ DN 050
050
[ DN 065
065
[ DN 080
080
[ DN 100
100
[ DN 125
125
[ DN 150
150
[ seal Viton
V
S seal EPDM
E
S seal NBR
N
[ rotor with 10 stainless steel clambs (RRI)
10K
S rotor with 10 titanium clambs (RRI)
10T
[ rotor with 5 magnet (RRH)
05M
[ PNP output
P
[ NPN output
N
S Namur output
A
[ ouput at suburb electronics (e.g. omni-RR)
E
K [ 2 m cable
S S connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
special applications: Switching output, frequency converter, current output and omni/flex processor
RRI-
032
MH
H 032 V 10K P
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
182
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow HV-...GM
turbine
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
5.1.
HV.
TECHNICAL DATA
brass
Type
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
HV-015GM
Qmax. rec.
l/min H2O
HV-008GM
HV-010GM
HV-015GM
HV-020GM
HV-025GM
pressure
media temperature
average pressure loss
6
10
15
30
50
40 mm/s
41-150 mm/s
0.6
1.2
1.2
2.1
2.1
2.5
3.0
3.0
3.7
3.7
3.5
4.0
4.0
5.0
5.0
A
mm
B
mm
C
mm
SW
mm
weight
kg
66
92
92
114
114
22
36
36
46
46
44
60
60
70
70
20
28
28
46
46
0.11
0.18
0.18
0.60
0.60
PN 10
max. 100C
0.2 bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
housing
connector
turbine
axle
bearing
glass
seal
PA 66
brass
PA 66 red
PA 66
steinless steel sphere
temperated glass
NBR
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
HV-
water
oil
With higher viscosity instruments
tend to higher starting values of the turbine.
008
008
010
015
020
025
G M
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
nominal
diameter
METERING SUBSTANCES
basic type
specification
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
female thread
brass connector
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
183
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RO-...TV
turbine
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
5.1.
RO.
The instruments are used for liquids while a turbine in fullplastic housing generates flow-dependent revolutions
which are detected optically.
not straight inline/ outline requirement
full-plastic design
for transparent liquids
integrated filter
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
RO-012TV015
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
metering range
l/min H2O
filter
m
pulse/
litre
d
mm
X
mm
L
mm
weight
kg
6
6
6
6
1.5
8
12
23
0.1 - 2
0.3 - 9
0.5 - 15
1.0 - 30
60
60
60
36000
8000
3200
1200
6.9
10
12
16
20
22
24
28
95
112
112
137
0.06
0.09
0.10
0.12
RO-007TV002
RO-010TV009
RO-012TV015
RO-016TV030
tolerance
linearity
repeatability
media temperature
average pressure loss
1%
1%
1%
max. 85C
0.5 to 1bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
wetted parts
seal
bearings
PVDF
polymere
PVDF
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
ELECTRICAL DATA
infra red-opto-electric
supply 5..12 V DC 6..33 mA
with integrated wiring protection
exit signal 5..11 V square-wave
frequency 20-800 Hz
cable 1 metre
aggressive liquids
oil up to 5mm/s
brow n (signal)
green
(shielded)
NOMENCLATURE
RO-
water
w hite
007
007
010
012
016
002
002
009
015
030
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
basic type
specification
nozzle 6.9
nozzle 10
nozzle 12
nozzle 16
nozzle
PVDF
metering range 0.1 - 2 l/min
metering range 0.3 - 9 l/min
metering range 0.5 - 15 l/min
metering range 1.0 - 30 l/min
ACCESSORIES
For type RO-007TV a filtre FRP4174 is compulsory for protection
of the moving parts. Please order seperately.
All technical changes reserved
[BASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
184
Basic
Flowmeter
Lineflow RRF
turbine
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
5.1.
RRF.
E
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
G3/8A
G3/8A
G3/8A
G3/8A
RRF-010AN005
RRF-010AN010
RRF-010AN015
RRF-010AN030
tolerance
repeatability
media temperature
ambient temperature
PN
bar
metering range
l/min H2O
pulse / litre
frequency output
Hz
pressure loss
code
weight
g
14
14
14
14
0.5 - 5
1.0 - 10
1.0 - 15
2.0 - 30
6900
3300
2200
1000
58 - 575
55 - 550
37 - 550
33 - 500
A
A
A
B
40
40
40
40
3% of reading
0,5% full scale
-20..100C
max. 80C
PRESSURE LOSS
bar
1.2
A
B
0.8
0.4
10
20
30
l/min
MATERIALS
housing
turbine
bearings
PA 12
PA 12
PTFE 15% graphite
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
185
Basic
turbine
Flowmeter
Lineflow RRF
5.1.
RRF.
ELECTRICAL DATA
brow n
-
blac k
MOUNTING POSITION
red
output
0 V DC
1k..2,2kohms (+) customer supplied
5..24 V DC
METERING SUBSTANCES
a filter < 50m is recommended
water
oil up to 16mm/s
NOMENCLATURE
RRF
010
010
A N
A
005
005
010
015
030
K
F
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 10 - G3/8A
male thread
housing material nylon
metering range 0,5- 5 l/min
metering range 1,0-10 l/min
metering range 1,0-15 l/min
metering range 1,0-30 l/min
cable
spade terminals
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
186
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RRT
turbine
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
5.1.
RRT.
RRT-020GM
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
RRT-020GP050
RRT-020GP080
RRT-020GM050
RRT-020GM080
PN
bar
metering range
l/min H2O
impulse/
litre
weight
kg
10
10
100
100
1 - 50
2 - 80
1 - 50
2 - 80
100
150
100
150
0.15
0.15
0.60
0.60
tolerance
media temperature
ambient temperature
3% EW
-25..90C
-25..60C
PRESSURE LOSS
ELECTRICAL DATA
Hall-sensor
NPN, NPN open collector
supply voltage 5..24 VDC; max 26.4 VDC
quiescent current consumption 10mA
conection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
protection class IP67
NPN oc
brow n
1
black
4
blue
3
50l/min
20
40
60
80
l/min
MATERIALS
housing
turbine
+
signal
0V
NOMENCLATURE
POM or brass nickel plated
ULTEM 1000 nature, PEI
Rubin DU-B , strotzium ferrite
1.4125, Bronze bridges PTFE plated
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
P
M
050
080
M
N
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
S [
water
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN20 - G3/4
female thread
housing POM
housing brass
range 1 - 50 l/min
range 2 - 80 l/min
electronic output NPN oc
electronic output NPN
electronic output Namur
(only for housing plastic)
electronic output 2-Leiter
electronic output by local
electronic ( e.g.omni-RRT )
connection at
locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
electronic output by local
electronic ( e.g.omni-RRT )
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
187
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RRT1
turbine
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
RRT1-010GM
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
RRT1-010GP050
RRT1-010GP080
RRT1-010GM050
RRT1-010GM080
PN
bar
metering range
l/min H2O
impulse/
litre
weight
kg
10
10
100
100
1 - 50
2 - 80
1 - 50
2 - 80
100
150
100
150
0.10
0.10
0.50
0.50
tolerance
media temperature
ambient temperature
3% EW
-25..90C
-25..60C
PRESSURE LOSS
pressure loss / bar
3
80l/min
2
50l/min
20
40
60
80
l/min
MATERIALS
housing
turbine
188
5.1.
RRT1.
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RRT1
turbine
5.1.
RRT1.
ELECTRICAL DATA
Hall-sensor
NPN, NPN open collector
supply voltage 5..24 VDC; max 26.4 VDC
quiescent current consumption 10mA
conection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
protection class IP67
NPN oc
1
4
3
MOUNTING POSITION
brow n
black
blue
+
signal
0V
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
NOMENCLATURE
basic type
specification
[ nominal diameter DN 10 - G3/8
010
[ female thread
G
[ connection brass
M
[ connection plastic POM
P
[ housing brass
M
[ housing plastic POM
P
[ range 1 - 50 l/min
050
[ range 2 - 80 l/min
080
[ seal Viton
V
S seal EPDM
E
S seal NBR
N
[ electronic output NPN open collector
M
[ electronic output NPN
N
S electronic output Namur ( only for housing plastic POM )
A
S electronic output 2-wire
Z
S electronic output by local electronic (e.g. omni-RRT1)
E
[ connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
S
[ connection by local electronic (e.g. omni-RRT1)
[ connection pure
O
S connection with Filter ( intake )
F
S connection with check valve ( intake )
R
[ connection pure
O
S connection with flow regulator 3 l/min ( outlet )
03
S connection with flow regulator 5 l/min ( outlet )
05
S connection with flow regulator 6 l/min ( outlet )
06
S connection with flow regulator 8 l/min ( outlet )
08
S connection with flow regulator 10 l/min ( outlet )
10
S connection with flow regulator 12 l/min ( outlet )
12
S connection with flow regulator 15 l/min ( outlet )
15
special applications: Switching output, frequency converter, current output and omni/flex processor
RRT1-
010
G M P
050
S O
OPTION
Flow regulator (options)
limiter flow rates
pressure range
max. differential
pressure
tolerance
materials
3 ; 5; 6 ; 8 ; 10 ; 12 ; 15
2 - 10 bar
16 bar
15%
POM, NBR, stainless steel 1.4571
POM, NBR
Filter (options)
mesh size
materials
250m
POM, stainless steel 1.4301
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
189
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RT-...AK
turbine
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
5.1.
RT.
RT-020AK004P
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
PN
l/min
RT-015AK001.
RT-020AK002.
RT-020AK004.
RT-020AK008.
RT-025AK016.
RT-040AK034.
RT-050AK068.
250
250
250
250
250
250
250
1.8 18
3.7 37
6.7 67
13.3 - 133
26.7 - 267
56.7 - 567
113.3 - 1133
tolerance
media temperature
tolerated particles
average pressure loss
m/h
pulses/
litre
10%
H
mm
L
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
0.11 - 1.1
0.22 - 2.2
0.40 - 4.0
0.80 - 8.0
1.60 - 16.0
3.40 - 34.0
6.80 - 68.0
2900
1700
1100
400
190
60
24
G 1/2 A
G 3/4 A
G 3/4 A
G 3/4 A
G1A
G 1 1/2 A
G2A
71
74
74
74
78
84
89
64
64
64
83
88
114
132
19
19
19
22
23
28
29
0.30
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.60
1.40
1.90
1% of full scale
<10 to 100% of metering range
inclusive linearitaty and repeatability
max. 85C
0.5mm
0.3bar at Qmax.
OPTION
media temperatuer 150C compatible to all
Honsberg-electronics sensors or electronics heads
MATERIALS
housing
turbine
bearings
ball bearings
stainless steel
stainless steel
wolfram carbit
stainless steel
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
190
Basic
Flowmeter
Rototron RT-...AK
turbine
ELECTRICAL DATA
wiring 0.319
PNP
1
4
3
MOUNTING POSITION
z=load
brow n
z
blue
RT.
NPN
1
black
5.1.
output
0V
brow n
black
blue
+
output
0V
METERING SUBSTANCES
10 x diam. as smoothing
section on inlet and
outlet
water
aggressive liquids
oil up to 5mm/s
NOMENCLATURE
basic type
specification
[
015
DN 15 - G1/2A
[
020
DN 20 - G3/4A
[
025
DN 25 - G1A
[
040
DN 40 - G1 1/2A
[
050
DN 50 - G2A
[
A
male thread
[
K
stainless steel design
[
001
0.11 - 1.1 m/h
[
002
0.22 - 2.2 m/h
[
004
0.40 - 4.0 m/h
[
008
0.80 - 8.0 m/h
[
016
1.60 - 16.0 m/h
[
034
3.40 - 34.0 m/h
[
068
6.80 - 68.0 m/h
P [
PNP
N [
NPN
E [
exit by local electronic (e.g. omni-TTH)
S
Programme option
flange design
temperature max. 120C (NPN)
BASIC
0
Special option
DN 80-300 PN16
design for air/gas
VARIO
range from 0.05 m/h
Accessories
EX amplifier EEV1 product information 80.1.EEV1.
015
A K
001
metering range
(1-5mm/s)
nominaldi
RT-
COMBINATIONS
omni-RT
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)..20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
further transformers
Flex
switching and frequency exit, 0..10V or 4..20mA, pnp, npn
ESA1
electronic monitoring unit
ESK2
2 switchpoints - supply 24 V DC
ESK3
1 switchpoint - supply 230 V AC
conceived for safety-relevant
applications
EFFS
switch output
EFFI
current output 4(0)..20mA
EFFF
frequency output
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
191
Basic
gear wheel
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flowmeter
Volutron VHZ-...GA/GK
6.1.
VHZ.
TECHNICAL DATA
s.s.
aluminium
G1/4
G3/8
G3/4
G3/4
G1
G1/4
G3/8
Type
VHZ-008GA
VHZ-010GA
VHZ-020GA
VHZO-020GA
VHZ-025GA
VHZ-008GK
VHZ-010GK
accuracy
reproducebility
media temperature
PN
bar
metering range
l/min
frequency
weight
kg
200
200
200
100
100
160
200
0.02 - 2
0.1 - 6
0.5 - 50
0.5 - 50
3.0 - 150
0.02 - 2
0.1 - 6
0.5
0.5
1.6
1.6
6.3
1.5
1.5
3 % full skale
(in reference to 20 mm/s)
0.3%
-25..80C
optionally -25..120C
(only 2-wire-execution DN10-25)
MOUNTING
Any installation position is possible and the the flow direction is
independent.
Take care of a clean pipe line. With larger particles in flow the
employment of a filter of 30m for protection is recommended.
MATERIALS
housing
gear and axle
bearings
seal
sight glass
VHZ-...GA
aluminium anodized
stainless steel 1.4462
Iglidur X
viton
glass ( only VHZO )
VHZ-010-025GK
stainless steel 1.4404
stainless steel 1.4462
Iglidur X
viton
VHZ-008GK
stainless steel 1.4404
stainless steel 1.4462
stainless steel 1.4037/1.4016 /PVD plated
Viton
192
Basic
gear wheel
Flowmeter
Volutron VHZ-...GA/GK
6.1.
VHZ.
DIMENSIONS
VHZ-008 / VHZ-010
VHZ-025
VHZ-008 G1/4
VHZ-010 G3/8
VHZ-020
FUNCTIONAL DIAGRAMS
Noise level / flow rate
VHZ-008
The noise level of the VHZ-008 is <50db (A) in case of 2 l/min.
VHZ-010
The noise level of the VHZ-010 is <50db (A) in case of 6 l/min.
VHZ-025
The noise level of the VHZ-025 is <70db (A) in case of 150 l/min.
VHZ-020
db (A )
70
65
60
55
50
10
20
30
40
50
l/min
193
Basic
gear wheel
Flowmeter
Volutron VHZ-...GA/GK
6.1.
VHZ.
VHZ-008
VHZ-020
cm 3
cm 3
0,043
2,10
0,042
2,05
0,041
2,00
0,040
1,95
0,039
0,5
1,90
1,5
10
20
30
40
50
l/m in
l/min
VHZ-010
VHZ-025
cm 3
cm 3
0,210
5,40
0,205
5,30
0,200
5,20
0,195
5,10
0,190
5,00
30
60
90
120
150
l/m in
l/min
VHZ-020
100mm/s
1000mm/s
34mm/s
100mm/s
34mm/s
10mm/s
0.5
2 l/min
1.5
VHZ-010
10
20
30
50 l/min
1000m m /s
1000m m /s
12
100m m /s
600m m /s
8
34m m /s
34m m /s
10m m /s
5m m /s
6 l/m in
0
50
100
194
40
VHZ-025
150 l /m in
Basic
Flowmeter
Volutron VHZ-...GA/GK
gear wheel
6.1.
VHZ.
ELECTRICAL DATA
PNP/NPN-Execution
supply voltage
quiescent current
short-circuit proof
Kurzschlussfest
connection
Schutzart
PNP
1
2
3
VHZ-010 to 025
10..30 V DC
<25mA without load
yes
yes
plug DIN 43650-A
IP 65
VHZ-008
24V10%
<30mA without load
yes
ja
blac k
z
blue
VHZ-010 to 025
4,5..24 VDC (V12)
low 6mA examplary
high 6mA + V 12/330Ohm
yes
plug DIN 43650-A
IP 65
short-circuit proof
connection
Schutzart
VHZ-008
12 VDC
7mA
14mA
no
2-w ire
NPN
brow n
2-Wire-Execution
supply voltage
quiescent current
output
0V
brow n
blac k
blue
+
output
output
0V
0V
Please be sure that there is the right power supply before you connect the device.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
basic type
specification
[ Flowmeter
VHZ[ Flowmeter with sight glass ( only VHZO-020 - 100 bar )
VHZO[ nominal diameter DN 8 - G1/4
008
[ nominal diameter DN 10 - G3/8
010
[ nominal diameter DN 20 - G3/4
020
[ nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
025
[ female thread
G
[ aluminium
A
S stainless steel DN 8 (160 bar) and DN 10
K
[ 0.02 - 2 l/min (VHZ-008)
002
[ 0.1 - 6 l/min (VHZ-010)
006
[ 0.5 - 50 l/min (VHZ-020)
050
[ 3 - 150 l/min (VHZ-025)
150
P [ PNP output
N [ NPN output
Z S 2-wire
E [ ouput at suburb electronics (for axamples omni-VHZ)
S media temperature -20C..120C
Sonderoption
(only 2-Wire-Execution VHZ-010 and VHZ-020 without sight glass)
VARIO
Zubehr
EX amplifier EEV1 product information 80.1.EEV1.
Universal preset counter EEZ904 product information 83.1.EEZ904.
PLUS
special applications: Switching output, frequency converter, current output and omni/flex processor
VHZ-
008
G A
002
COMBINATIONS
omni-VHZ
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)..20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
further transformers
Flex
switching and frequency exit, 0..10V or 4..20mA, pnp, npn
ESA1
electronic monitoring unit
ESK2
2 switchpoints - supply 24 V DC
ESK3
1 switchpoint - supply 230 V AC
conceived for safety-relevant
applications
EFFS
switch output
EFFI
current output 4(0)..20mA
EFFF
frequency output
All technical changes reserved
[BASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
195
Basic
Flowmeter
Volutron VHO-...GP
oval wheel
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
6.2.
VHO.
VHO-008GPT
POM
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. rec.
l/min
G 1/4
G 1/4
G 1/2
G 3/4
VHO-008GP.080
VHO-008GP.100
VHO-015GP.250
VHO-020GP.400
10
10
10
10
12
12
30
50
tolerance
media temperature
average pressure loss
10mm/s
0.3 - 8.0
0.4 - 10.0
1.0 - 25.0
1.6 - 40.0
100mm/s
0.3 - 8.0
0.4 - 10.0
1.0 - 25.0
1.6 - 40.0
320mm/s
0.2 - 5.0
0.3 - 8.0
1.0 - 25.0
1.6 - 40.0
pulse/litre
weight
kg
429
224
52,5
28
0.4
0.4
0.7
1.1
800mm/s
0.1 - 2.0
0.15 - 4.0
0.4 - 10.0
0.95 - 24.0
MATERIALS
housing
cover
oval wheel
signal initiator
axle
seal
POM
POM, option PMMA (transparent)
POM
1.4301
1.4301
NBR
Type
A
mm
H
mm
L1
mm
L2
mm
VHO-008GP.080
VHO-008GP.100
VHO-015GP.250
VHO-020GP.400
G 1/4
G 1/4
G 1/2
G 3/4
68
68
99
119
45
49
71 *
84,5 *
21,5
21
19
17
13,5
14
16
18
196
Basic
Flowmeter
Volutron VHO-...GP
oval wheel
ELECTRICAL DATA
inductive sensor
PNP, asymmetrically 18..30 V DC max. 120mA (typ. 10mA)
cable 2 m
protection class IP 65
MOUNTING POSITION
brow n
PNP
6.2.
VHO.
+ 18..30V DC
black
o la 120mA
blue
- GND
METERING SUBSTANCES
oil 10-800mm/s
NOMENCLATURE
VHO-
008
G P
008
015
020
P
A
080
P
T
A
080
100
250
400
[
[
[
[
[
S
[
S
S
[
[
[
[
[
S
P
A
PRESSURE LOSS
VHO-008GP.080
pressure loss / bar
800mm/s
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 8 - G1/4
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 20 - G3/4
female thread
housing material POM
housing material Aluminium
cover material POM
cover material PMMA (transparent)
cover material Aluminium
measuring range 0.3 - 8 l/min
measuring range 0.4 - 10 l/min
measuring range 1.0 - 25 l/min
measuring range 1.6 - 40 l/min
exit PNP
exit Namur
VHO-008GP.100
pressure loss / bar
320mm/s
800mm/s
320mm/s
0,75
100mm/s
0,75
100mm/s
0,5
46mm/s
10mm/s
0,5
46mm/s
10mm/s
0,25
0
0,25
2
8 l/min
VHO-015GP.250
pressure loss / bar
10 l/min
VHO-020GP.400
pressure loss / bar
800mm/s
320mm/s
800mm/s
0,75
100mm/s
0,75
320mm/s
0,5
46mm/s
10mm/s
0,5
100mm/s
46mm/s
10mm/s
0,25
0,25
0
10
15
20
25 l/min
10
20
30
40 l/min
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
197
Why to use a
Basic
rotor instrument
installation comfort
l Cover transparent
l Sensor option
inductive, optical or
magnetic
contactless actuation
198
Where to use a
Basic
rotor instrument
Market segments
l Semiconductor
l Medical installation
l Welding
Application
l Continuous flow related signals in wafer production
l Continuous flow signals in cooling panels for X-ray installations
l Continuous signals to command cooling rate in welding
automates
199
Why to use a
Basic
l No moving parts
reliable
versatile
l Magnetic calibration
easy programming on
location
200
Calorimetric
The difference in temperature between
two temperature sensors is directly proportional to the flow rate and/or flow
speed if one of the temperature sensors
is heated.
Magnetic inductive
The conductive metering medium moves
vertically to a magnetic field and thus
induces a metering voltage which is
directly proportional to the flow speed.
Vortex
A small triangular piece that covers the
entire cross-section of the flowmeter
creates a vortex in the flow. The vortex
frequency is proportional to the flow rate
and is detected by a Piezo sensor that is
located behind the triangular piece.
F
Contents
Calorimetric
202
magnetic inductive
205
Vortex
206
Gertebeschreibungen
207
Application
l Flow monitoring and material using sensor technology
l No moving parts inside
Advantages
l Simple structure and installation
l Independent of nominal diameters
l Wear-free and low pressure loss function
Technical data
Concept
Probe
Nominal diameter
15 - 400
Connection
stub-connection
PN
6 - 25
threshold, 4 [0]..20 mA
Adjustable
yes
Materials
stainless steel
l Switching
l Indicating
l Metering
201
Basic
Calorimetric
Advantages:
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
The variety of sensor options fits almost all operational conditions. If not
we are in the position to adjust our instrument to the individual
application.
Fields of use
Principle
The calorimetric system is based two temperature sensors witch are
positioned within good temperature conductivity versus the liquid involved.
basic arrangements of the sensor
elements
One sensor is permanently heated with the effect that a constant temperature difference between the sensors will be established. In case of
a velocity of the liquid this temperature difference is modified. This modification is the measure for the flow control.
The unheated sensor registers the liquid temperature and triggers a
temperature compensation. This effects a stability of temperature behaviour with flow velocity and an accurate flow control.
The slope of the curve for a calorimetric sensor becomes less as the
flow rate increases, which means
that the difference signal to be evaluated becomes increasingly smaller.
202
Various liquids and different sensor housing materials affect the response time, because the thermal conductivity is changing. Generally, the
lower the thermal conductivity of the medium and the housing material,
the higher the medium flow rate must be to receive satisfactory results.
l medium water - sensor stainless steel - heat conductivity
high => low flow rate required approx. 1..150 cm/s
l Medium oil r - sensor stainless steel - heat conductivity
medium => medium flow rate required approx. 3..300 cm/s
The switch-on and switch-off times are the periods after which the
regular measuring variable is acquired following a rapid increase or
decrease in the flow rate. With a medium temperature of approx. 25
C and with a stainless steel sensor used in water, the average switchon and switch-off times are approx. 2 s. Please bear in mind that this
time depends on the operating conditions. In cases where the media or
sensor materials are poor thermal conductors, the switching times
might increase.
The temperature range of the medium is the range of medium temperature in which the calorimetric sensor works without problem.
Basic
Mounting instructions
In principal all installation locations are feasible where the sensor housing may be positioned into circumferent contact with the liquid (see
drawing):
Contamination and air bubbles shoud be avoided. In case of bending
tube sectors the liquid conditions may change which might cause flow
whirls and other instability effecting the quality of emitted signals.
After insertion and sealing (e.g. using a Sikurit seal) all sensors can be
rotated with continuous adjustment of the head. This feature facilitates
the precise orientation of the cable and, for the compact-type of sensor,
the easy alignment of the indicating head.
socket and nominal size (standard):
Type
G1/4A
probelength
28
G1/2A
G1/2A
29,6
45
...-015HK029
...-015HK045
...-008HK028
nominal
diameter DN
DN 10-15
DN 20-25
DN 15-32
DN 25-....
socket
dimension H
20
15
18
32
204
Electrical Installation
2
1
5
4
3
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
1
Potentiometer min
(turn counter clock)
low flow indication, sensitivity low
and no green LEDs activated.
(Temperature alarm activated)
Potentiometer max
(turn clock wise)
high flow indication, sensitivity
high and chain of green LEDs
activated.
(Temperature alarm activated)
Magnetic inductive
Advantage
l no moving parts
l one sensor for a wide range of pipe diameters
l low pressure loss
205
Basic
Principle
If a conductor moves vertically in relation to a magnetic field, the movement will induce an electrical potential U in the conductor. In this measuring principle the electrically conductive measuring medium is the conductor. The magnetic field B is produced at right angles to the flow. The
induced electrical potential U is directly proportional to the local speed
of flow v.
U=kBvD
k
B
v
D
=
=
=
=
Mounting
The magnetic-inductive FIS probe is assembled into the pipe by support
of a sleeve welded into the relevant pipe to receive the sensor (min.pipe
diameter DN 5o). For installation position and depth see diagrams alternatively a clamp saddle arrangement may be used.
Inlet and outlet sections must be >= 10x diameter of pipe. Weld the
connector sleeve vertically to the centre of the pipe according to the
pipes nominal diameter (see marking = external pipe diameter). Do not
use force! The Probe must be screwed in hand tight.
The positions vertical are not
recommended due to air bubbles or
sediments in pipe.
Calibrated socket
welded into pipe at
diameter related mark
of scale.
After putting in place, the probe can be aligned by rotation (see electrical connection). The complete measuring probe is removable without
damaging the carrier, so that the electronic part can be exchanged in
case of defect.
Vortex
A small triangular piece (1) that covers the entire cross-section of the
flowmeter creates a vortex in the flow (Karmann vortex, vortex effect).
The vortex frequency is proportional to the flow rate and is detected by
a Piezo sensor (2) that is located behind the triangular piece. The entire
unit, vortex piece and sensor, is designed as a module (3) and is inserted into the meter. Thus, the flowmeter and the entire measuring unit
can be separated quickly.
Advantages
206
3
3
3
3
208
EFKM
l
l
l
l
100
100
70
70
l
l
3
3
3
3
208
EFK2
l
l
l
l
100
100
70
70
l
l
3
3
3
3
210
Flex-FIN
100
70
212
EFKS
l
l
l
l
100
100
70
70
l
l
3
3
3
3
215
type
calorimetric
connection
60
215
indukti-
converter
FIS
l
l
25
10
150
150
l
l
Vortex
EEFK
page
oil
l
l
miscellaneous
water
70
70
aggressive
max. temperature C
100
100
gas/air
l
l
on site metering
indication
l
l
output signal
control
nominal diameter
EFKP
CF
l
l
l
16
16
16
80
80
80
l
l
l
3
3
3
217
220
220
220
HONSBERG KOMBISYSTEM
Standard
sensor
G1/2A
G1/2A
G1/4A
Food flange
l standard
m standard option
special option
207
Basic
calorimetric
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
EFKP/EFKM
10.2.
EFKP/M
TECHNICAL DATA
operating ranges
MONTAGE
If you would like to exploit the highest possible sensor
sensitivity (for particularly low flow rates or for use in
gases), orientate the cross on hexagonal body of
probe(liquids) or the red dot (gases) into a position against
flow direction ( flow meets cross or dot). See also the
general description on calorimetric sensors.
Advantages EFKM:
-
goose-neck
temperatures
option
MATERIALS
medium contact
other
208
for
higher
Basic
Flow Switch
EFKP/EFKM
calorimetric
ELECTRICAL DATA
display
setting potentiometer
supply voltage
current consumption
signal
load
connection
short-circuit proof
reverse polarity proof
protection class
EFKP/M
brow n
w hite
blue
black
NPN
1
2
3
4
MOUNTING POSITION
10.2.
Temp.
0V
Flow
brow n
z
w hite
blue
black
z=load
+
Temp.
0V
Flow
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
EFKP- 015 H K 029 P
EFKPEFKPTEFKMEFKMT-
008
015
038
H
L
029
028
045
056
S
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Y
Q
Y
Y
Q
Y
Q
Y
Y
P
N
S
H
basic type
specification
calorimetric
Flow Switch
connection G1/4A
connection G1/2A
connection footstuffs sensor ISO 2852 size 38
socket thread
footstuffs sensor
stainless steel 1.4571
probe length 29.6mm
probe length 28mm
probe length 45mm
probe length 56mm
PNP output
NPN output
Locking plug KPU-02SG
M12x1, 4-polr, cable 2 m, straight plug
with goose-neck
ACCESSORY
Locking plug M12x1
PU-
K
KB04
PU-
02
02
05
10
S G
G
W
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
basic type
specification
ready-made cable
self makable cable 4-pole
material PUR
length 2 m
length 5 m
length 10 m
moulded-on plug
straight plug
angled plug 90
All technical changes reserved
YBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
209
Basic
calorimetric
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Flow Switch
EFK2
10.2.
EFK2.
TECHNICAL DATA
operating ranges
MOUNTING
If you would like to exploit the highest possible sensor
sensitivity (for particularly low flow rates or for use in
gases), orientate the cross on hexagonal body of
probe(liquids) or the red dot (gases) into a position against
flow direction ( flow meets cross or dot). See also the
general description on calorimetric sensors.
locking plug (accessories)
goose-neck
temperatures
option
for
higher
MATERIALS
medium contact
other
210
Basic
Flow Switch
EFK2
calorimetric
10.2.
EFK2.
ELECTRICAL DATA
display
red/green LED
(red < limit value,
green > limit value)
single-threaded
24 V DC / AC 10%
max. 70mA
galvanic separation,
Relais contact (NO) or
transistor PNP/NPN
2A / 30 V DC/ AC (Relais)
24V 100 mA (Transistor)
at locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
yes
yes
IP65
setting potentiometer
supply voltage
current consumption
signal
load
connection
short-circuit proof
reverse polarity proof
protection class
PNP
1
4
3
NPN
1
4
3
MOUNTING POSITION
24V DC / AC
signal
brow n
black
z
blue
brow n
black
blue
output
z=load
0V
+
output
0V
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
EFK2- 015 H K 029 O S
EFK2-
008
015
038
H
L
029
028
045
056
Y
Y
Y
Q
Y
Q
Y
Y
Q
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
O
C
P
N
S
H
basic type
specification
calorimetric Flow Switch
connection G1/4A
connection G1/2A
connection footstuffs sensor ISO 2852 size 38
socket thread
footstuffs sensor
stainless steel 1.4571
probe length 29.6mm
probe length 28mm
probe length 45mm
probe length 56mm
relay contact (NO)
relay contact (NC)
PNP output
NPN output
Locking plug KPU-02SG
M12x1, 4-pole, cable 2 m, straight plug
with goose-neck
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
211
Basic
Flex-FIN
calorimetric
52.2.
Flex-FIN
TERMINAL ASSIGNMENT
Before the electrical installation, make sure that the supply voltage
corresponds to the data provided!
brow n
1
w hite
2
3
+ 24 V DC 10%
A nalogue Output
blue
4 blac k
0V
z
PNP NPN
Z = Last
BENEFIT
The Flex-FIN flow sensor monitors liquid media. In a compact
design, it combines the installation sensing element and evaluation
electronics that, according to the respective version, control a limit
value output with a PNP or NPN transistor output or an analogue
output (4..20 mA or 0..10 V) or both. The limit switch can
alternatively be replaced by a frequency output.
The evaluation electronics record two processing parameters: the
flow speed of the medium and its temperature. Both parameters can
be assigned to the analogue output or the switching output.
Please you use shielded cable, signal lines < 30m and
power supply lines < 10m.
MOUNTING
To maintain the greatest possible interference insensitivity of the
sensor, the flow should be from the bottom to the top (best
ventilation even in case of the lowest flow velocity). For the
connection, conventional crimp connectors, hoses with crimp
fasteners, or Honsberg's own crimp connectors can be used.
For the best possible insulation from the outside environment,
insulating hoses that may not be removed can be used.
PROGRAMMING
Designs with a limit switch have a magnetic contact by means of
which the current measurement value can be assumed as a limit
value. It is programmed by applying a magnet to the marking on the
type plate for 0.5 to 2 seconds. If the contact time is too short or too
long, no programming will take place (protection against magnetic
fields). Immediately after programming, the switching output enters
the OK state (LED on, output switched through, e.g. PNP = high or
NPN = low).
analogue
Y
Y
Y
flow
switching output
temperature
analogue switching output
Y
Y
Y
Y
212
Basic
calorimetric
Flex-FIN
52.2.
Flex-FIN
TECHNICAL DATA
6 mm-pipe (0.001) 0.01..2 l/min
8 mm-pipe 0.025..5 l/min
10 mm-pipe 0.05..10 l/min
() = special range on request
4C/s
temperature gradient
0..70C
measurement range
(-20..100C on requeston request)
temperature
-20..80C
storage temperature
max. 10 bar (other on request)
pressure
max. 0.3 bar at max. flow
pressure loss
at locking plug M 12x1, 5-pole
connection
IP65
protection class
appr. 200 g
weigth
range
(water)
supply voltage
power consumption
switching output
switching hysteresis
display (only in case of
switching output)
adjustment
analogue output
materials
24 VDC 10%
max. 100 mA
transistor output "push pull"
short circuit proof,
reverse polarity protected,
Iout = 100mA max.
flow: 4% F.S.
temperature: approx. 2C
yellow LED
(ON = OK /OFF = alarm)
via magnet
4..20 mA, max. load 500 Ohm
or 0..10V. min load 1 kOhm
media contact stainless steel 1.4305
other: PPS, PA66, brass nickel plated
DIMENSIONS
213
Basic
52.2.
Flex-FIN
calorimetric
Flex-FIN
NOMENCLATURE
Example:
Flex-FIN
A
006 R K
L O
A sensor family:
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Options:
special measurement range, flow:
measurement range initial value
l/min
l/min
power-on delay
(time after the supply is created; in this time
the switching output is not activated)
ACCESSORIES
Locking plug M12x1
PU-
K
KB04
PU-
02
02
05
10
S G S
G
W
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
basic type
specification
assembled
self makable cable 4-pole
material PUR
length 2 m
length 5 m
length 10 m
moulded-on plug
straight plug
angled plug 90
shielded
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
214
cm/s
C
Hz
cm/s
C
cm/s
C
%
Basic
Flow Switch
EFKS + EEFK
calorimetric
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
10.2.
EFKS.
EFKS
EEFK
TECHNICAL DATA
operating ranges
EFKS
MOUNTING
If you would like to exploit the highest possible sensor
sensitivity (for particularly low flow rates or for use in
gases), orientate the cross on hexagonal body of
probe(liquids) or the red dot (gases) into a position against
flow direction ( flow meets cross or dot). See also the
general description on calorimetric sensors.
EEFK
MATERIALS
medium contact
other
electronic housing
215
Basic
Flow Switch
EFKS + EEFK
calorimetric
10.2.
EFKS.
ELEKTRISCHE DATEN
display
red/green LED
(red < limit value,
single-threaded
24 V DC 20% / 70mA for
unloaded output
230 VA / 7 VA
PNP or NPN / 200mA
add. change over contacts
230V AC 5A (only for
230 VDC types)
PNP or NPN / 200mA
add. change over contacts
230V AC 5A (only for
230VDC types)
floor mounting or
clip fastening on mounting
rails (DIN EN 50 022)
at locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
screw terminals
< 1.5mm with
wire-end ferrules
yes
yes
IP 67 EFKS
IP 30 EEFK front
setting potentiometer
supply voltage
signal flow
signal Temp.
temperature (EEFKT)
housing mounting
connection EFKS
connection EEFK
wire-core cross-section
short-circuit proof
reverse polarity proof
protection class
MOUNTING POSITION
1
Sensor
EFKS...
3
4
2
WH= white
BU= blue (green)
Temp. outputs only with EEFKT
brow n
11
blue (green)
black (yellow )
w hite
12 external
electronics
13 EEFK...
14
top
8 7
T em p. 230 V AC
Flow
bottom
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
OUT BN
Flow
0VDC
BU
BK
Sensor
WHOUT
T em p.
+24VDC
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
EFKS- 015 H K 029 S
EFKS-
008
015
038
H
L
EEFK- 015 H
EEFKEEFKT-
024
230
P
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
029
028
045
056
Y
Y
Y
Q
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Y
basic type
specification
calorimetric Flow Switch
connection G1/4A
connection G1/2A
connection footstuffs sensor ISO 2852 size 38
socket thread
footstuffs sensor
stainless steel 1.4571
probe length 29.6mm
probe length 28mm
probe length 45mm
probe length 56mm
Locking plug KPU-02SG - M12x1, 4-polr, cable 2 m, straight plug
basic type
specification
external evaluation units at calorimetric sensors
external evaluation units at calorimetric sensors with temperature switch
24 V DC (only PNP or NPN)
230 V AC (additional change-over contacts)
output PNP
output NPN
All technical changes reserved
YBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
216
Basic
Flowmeter
FIS
magnetic inductive
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
11.1.
FIS.
TECHNICAL DATA
measuring ranges
accuracy
reproducibility
time constant
measurement
substance
media conductivity
flow temperature
ambient temperature
system pressure
weight
PRINCIPLE
end range 1 to 8 m/s
in steps of 1 m/s
5 % of measured value
(calibration on site + 2 % of
measured value
2 % of measurement value
5 second fixed
lagely homogeneous fluids,
pastes can also include
solid Particles
min. 20 S/cm
-25..150C
-25..60C
max. 25 bar welded tube
max. 10 bar clamp saddle
2.4kg without clamp saddle
U=k . B . v . D
k = constant for the instrument
B = strength of magnetic field
v = local speed
D =distance between electrodes
FIS-025VK
FIS-...BB
MATERIALS
probe
isolation
clamp saddle
housing
DN
50
65
80
100
125
150
63
75
90
110
140
160
110
113
120
125
135
143
70
80
90
100
125
130
217
Basic
Flowmeter
FIS
magnetic inductive
11.1.
FIS.
MOUNTING
The magnetic-inductive FIS probe is assembled into the pipe by support of a sleeve welded into the relevant pipe to receive the sensor
(min.pipe diameter DN 5o). For installation position and depth see diagrams Alternatively a clamp saddle arrangement may be used.
Inlet and outlet sections must be >= 10x diameter of pipe. Weld the connector sleeve vertically to the centre of the pipe according to the
pipes nominal diameter (see marking = external pipe diameter). Do not use force! The Probe must be screwed in handtight.
After putting in place, the probe can be aligned by rotation (see electrical connection). The complete measuring probe is removable without
damaging the carrier, so that the electronic part can be exchanged in case of defect.
ELECTRICAL DATA
supply voltage
24V DC 10%
current consumtion
output
protection class
1
2
5
the
DIP
switch
= 3m/s
6 5 12 11
24 V DC
6 5 12 11
no error
: measurment activity,
current output 0(4)-20 mA
error
FE<10 Ohm
Earth
Must be
installed!
24 V DC
24 V DC
218
Basic
Flowmeter
FIS
magnetic inductive
MOUNTING POSITION
11.1.
FIS.
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
NOMENCLATURE
FIS-
025 V
V
B
K
B
end of scale
025
050
065
080
100
125
150
basic type
specification
Y
DN 025 (welded tube)
Y
DN 050
Y
DN 065
Y
DN 080
Y
DN 100
Y
DN 125
Y
DN 150
Y
welded tube
Y
clamp saddle
Y
stainless steel (welded tube)
Y
PP (clamp saddle)
Y
001
1 m/s
Y
002
2 m/s
Y
003
3 m/s
Y
004
4 m/s
Y
005
5 m/s
Y
006
6 m/s
Y
007
7 m/s
Y
008
8 m/s
G Y
cable gland Pg9 (cable not included)
S Q
connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
The FIS transducer is also available with a smart-electronic cover. This electronic includes a display, two
programmable switch points, frequency output, progr. filter, linearisation, memory of extrem values, totaliser,
choiseable unit on the display.
K 001 G
ACCESSORY
Locking plug M12x1
PU-
K
KB04
PU-
02
02
05
10
S G
G
W
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
basic type
specification
ready-made cable
self makable cable 4-pole
material PUR
length 2 m
length 5 m
length 10 m
moulded-on plug
straight plug
angled plug 90
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
219
Basic
vortex
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
14.1.
CF.
3
11
flow
high accuracy
large overload security
no moving parts
fast installation and removal by clamp attachment
modular construction with the most versatile
connection systems
CF-025GMM135UIS
TECHNICAL DATA
G
G 1/8
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
G 1 1/4
Type
CF-006GM.
CF-008GM.
CF-010GM.
CF-015GM.
CF-020GM.
CF-025GM.
CF-032GM.
tolerance
media temperature
storage temperature
cavitation
average pressure loss
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
range
l/min H2O
H
mm
L
mm
X
mm
SW
mm
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
7
15
30
50
85
135
240
0.6 - 7 l/min
1.0 - 15 l/min
2.5 - 30 l/min
4.5 - 50 l/min
6.0 - 85 l/min
8.5 - 135 l/min
15 - 240 l/min
114
114
114
114
114
114
114
88
88
88
92
96
100
108
12.5
12.5
12.5
14.5
16.5
18.5
22.5
38
38
38
38
38
38
46
2% of measured value
5..80C
-25..80C
not with Pwithdrawal / Pdifference 5.5
0.1 bar at Qmax.
OPERATION
The vortex flowmeter requires a feed distance of 5 - 10xD
to achieve its nominal precision. If deposits are feared, the
sensor should not be installed with the electronics pointing
downward. Please observe that the sensor is installed in
the direction of the flow arrow. For possible cleaning of the
sensor, loosen the clamps and remove the device (in the
process, the line should be depressurized. Make sure
that the vortex does not expose the oscillating body to
impacts (the spraying unit contains a very sensitive
ceramic piezo transducer that can break).
MATERIALS
housing
connectors
detector
seal
220
Basic
vortex
ELECTRICAL DATA
supply voltage
connection
short-circuit proff
reverse polarity proff
protection class
NPN
1
4
3
2
brow n
black
blue
CF.
10..30 V DC
for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
yes
yes
IP 67
14.1.
100 mA
current 4..20 mA
voltage 0..10V
frequency output / programmable switch
idle current
< 20 mA (without load)
output
PNP and NPN
10..2000 Hz
+
output
0V
w hite
programming
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
CF-
006 G M M 007 E
006
008
010
015
020
025
032
G
A
T
M
K
P
M
K
P
007
015
030
050
085
135
240
E
V
N
U S
U
I
F
S
E
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Q
Y
Q
Q
Y
Y
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 006
nominal diameter DN 008
nominal diameter DN 010
nominal diameter DN 015
nominal diameter DN 020
nominal diameter DN 025
nominal diameter DN 032
female thread
male thread
nozzle
connection material brass Ms 58 nickel plated
connection material stainless steel 1.4571
connection material POM
housing material brass Ms 58 nickel plated
housing material stainless steel 1.4571
housing material POM
range 0.6 - 7 l/min
range 1.0 - 15 l/min
range 2.5 - 30 l/min
range 4.5 - 50 l/min
range 6.0 - 85 l/min
range 8.5 - 135 l/min
range 15 - 240 l/min
seal EPDM
seal Viton
seal NBR
voltage output 0..10V
current output 4..20mA
frequency output
programmable switch (push pull PNP and NPN)
ouput at suburb electronics (e.g. omni-CF)
connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
COMBINATIONS
omni-CF
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)..20mA output
graphical LCD display with flashing LED
program ring
Flex-CF
switching and frequency exit
0..10V or 4..20mA
pnp, npn
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
221
Where to use a
electronic flow instrument
Basic
Market segments
l Machine tools
l Sewage
l Semi conductor
industry
l Welding
l Low pressure
cleaners
Application
l Flow rate monitoring and display in wafer production
l Flow rate alarm in control panels of robot welders
l Pump command in cleaning installations
222
Contents
System description
224
Device descriptions
225
Application
l Visual flow monitoring of liquids
Advantages
l Simple structure
l Double-faced viewing field
l Reliable function
Technical data
Concept
Nominal diameter
8 - 50
Connection
female thread
PN
6 - 16
Adjustable
Materials
l Indicating
223
Basic
System description
Device systems
Sight glass
The medium enters the device body and is usually visible through doublefaced glass windows.
Function:
Application:
Flap
The medium moves a flap built into the medium space. The position of
the flap is an indication of flow rate.
Function:
Application:
quantitative indication
monitoring transparent, clean liquids
Sphere
The position of the sphere in the glass dome indicates intensity of flow.
It may be used for liquids and gases.
Function:
Application:
yes/no display
monitoring transparent liquids or gases
70
227
OW
70
228
WO1
l
l
16
16
100
100
l
l
3
3
229
page
oil
miscellaneous
water
ON
aggressive
max.temperature C
226
gas/air
on site metering
output signal
200
indication
16
control
nominal diameter
connection
type
FK
16
170
230
FQ
16
200
231
SK
16
200
232
16
200
sphere
flap
sight glass
FH
l standard
BL
m standard option
special option
233
225
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow FH-...GR
sight glass
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
7.1.
FH.
FH-015GR
bronze
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
L
mm
B
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
FH-015GR
FH-020GR
FH-025GR
16
16
16
25
45
85
85
95
68
68
74
38
38
42
14
14
16
1.20
1.10
1.25
media temperature
average pressue loss
65
MATERIALS
body
ring
window
seal
bronze Rg5
brass Ms58
soda-lime glass
klingersil C4400
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
FH-
015
015
020
025
G R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 20 - G3/4
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
female thread
bronze
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
226
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow ON-...GM
sight glass
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
7.1.
ON.
ON-015GM
brass
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
ON-008GM
ON-010GM
ON-015GM
media temperature
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
D
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
6
6
6
15
20
5
8
12
19
27
32
11
11
10
0.08
0.16
0.20
40
max. 70C
MATERIALS
housing
tube
stained brass
natural glass
MOUNTING POSITION
Operation of the drip nose
with downward flow only.
NOMENCLATURE
ON-
008
008
010
015
G M
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 8 - G1/4
nominal diameter DN 10 - G3/8
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
female thread
brass
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
227
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow OW-...GM
sight glass
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
7.1.
OW.
OW-025GM
brass
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
G1
G 1 1/2
G2
OW-008GM
OW-010GM
OW-015GM
OW-025GM
OW-040GM
OW-050GM
media temperature
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
6
6
6
6
6
6
15
20
30
90
220
70
70
70
90
130
148
19
27
32
46
60
65
11
10
9
19
23
25
0.08
0.16
0.20
0.62
1.40
1.50
250
max. 70C
MATERIALS
G1-G2
brass nickel plated
acrylic
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
OW-
008
008
010
015
025
040
050
G M
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
nominal
diameter
G1/4-G1/2
stained brass
natural glass
body
tube
basic type
specification
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 25 - G1
DN 40 - G1 1/2
DN 50 - G2
female thread
brass
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
228
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow WO1-GM/GK
sight glass
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
7.1.
WO1.
WO1-010GM
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
L
mm
SW
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
G 1 1/4
G 1 1/2
WO1-008G.
WO1-010G.
WO1-015G.
WO1-020G.
WO1-025G.
WO1-032G.
WO1-040G.
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
15
20
30
60
90
150
220
71
71
86
94
104
120
130
36
36
46
46
46
65
65
9
9
13
16
16
19
20
0.3
0.3
0.6
0.6
0.6
1.6
1.6
media temperature
max. 100C
G
MATERIALS
MOUNTING POSITION
WO1-...GK
stainless steel 1.4305
duran glass
viton
viton
NOMENCLATURE
WO1-
008
G M
008
010
015
020
025
032
040
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
Programme option
BASIC
M
K
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
nominal diameter
WO1-...GM
brass Ms58 nickel plated
duran glass
NBR
NBR
housing
tube
wipers
seal
basic type
specification
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
DN 32 - G1 1/4
DN 40 - G1 1/2
female thread
brass design
stainless steel design
seal / wiper EPDM
oil
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
229
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow FK-...GR
flap
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
8.1.
FK.
FK-020GR
bronze/cast iron
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
L
mm
A
mm
B
mm
D
mm
X
mm
AF
mm
weight
kg
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
G 1 1/2
G2
FK-015GR
FK-020GR
FK-025GR
FK-040GR
FK-050GR
16
16
16
16
16
25
40
60
120
90
90
110
130
170
60
60
76
90
114
74
74
95
116
138
40
40
49
60
80
14
14
18
20
25
36
36
43
61
74
0.85
0.80
1.60
3.00
5.90
media temperature
average pressure loss
250
MATERIALS
bronze / cast iron
cast iron
hard glass
flexicarb with metal enforcement
stainless steel 1.4436
polysulfon
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
FK-
015
015
020
025
040
050
G R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
nominal
diameter
body
cover
window
seal
body
flap
basic type
specification
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
DN 40 - G1 1/2
DN 50 - G2
female thread
bronze/cast iron
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
230
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow FQ-...GR
flap
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
8.1.
FQ.
TECHNICAL DATA
G
FQ-015GR017
PN
bar
Type
indication range
l/min H2O
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
L
mm
B
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
2.1 - 17
2.1 - 20
25
45
65
85
85
95
68
68
74
36
36
42
14
14
16
1.20
1.10
1.25
bronze
FQ-015GR017
G 1/2
16
G 3/4
FQ-020GR020
16
G1
FQ-025GR024
16
Scale increments 1 to 10. Calibration see nomenclature.
media temperature
average pressure loss
2.1 - 24
MATERIALS
body
ring
window
seal
bolt
flap
scale
bronze
brass
soda-lime-glass
klingersil C4400
stainless steel 1.4305
stainless steel 1.4310
stainless steel 1.4310
MOUNTING POSITION
FQ-
015
015
020
025
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
G R
017
017
020
024
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 20 - G3/4
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
female thread
bronze
indication range 2.1- 17 l/min H2O
indication range 2.1- 20 l/min H2O
indication range 2.1- 24 l/min H2O
Scale increments 1 to 10. Indication value is indicated for horizontally increasing flow.
scale increments
indication range
l/min H2O
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1
2,1- 17
2,1- 20
2,1- 24
2.1
2.1
2.1
3.2
3.2
4.0
3.8
4.5
5.0
4.3
5.2
7.0
4.7
5.6
7.8
5.0
6.3
9.2
5.7
7.5
9.5
7.5
8.9 11.6
11.1 14.0 17.8
17
20
24
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
231
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow SK-...GR
flap
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
8.1.
SK.GR
TECHNICAL DATA
G
SK-020GR025
PN
bar
Type
indicating range
l/min H2O
Qmax. recom.
l/min H2O
L
mm
A
mm
B
mm
D
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
30
40
60
120
250
90
90
110
130
170
60
60
76
90
114
74
74
95
116
138
40
40
49
60
80
36
36
43
61
74
14
14
18
20
25
1.0
1.0
1.8
3.4
5.9
bronze/cast iron
3 - 25
16
G 1/2
SK-015GR025
3 - 25
16
G 3/4
SK-020GR025
5 - 40
16
G1
SK-025GR040
10 - 76
G 1 1/2 SK-040GR076
16
G2
16
SK-050GR195
15 -195
Scale increments 1 - 10. Calibration see nomenclature.
media temperature
average pressure loss
MATERIALS
body
cover
window
seal
bolt
flap
scale
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
basic type
specification
Z
015
DN 15 - G1/2
Z
020
DN 20 - G3/4
Z
025
DN 25 - G1
Z
040
DN 40 - G1 1/2
Z
050
DN 50 - G2
Z female thread
G
Z bronze
R
Z indicating range 3 - 25 l/min H 2O
025
Z indicating range 5 - 40 l/min H 2O
040
Z indicating range 10 - 76 l/min H2O
076
Z indicating range 15 - 195 l/min H2O
195
0 stainless steel design
Special option
flange connector in cast iron
VARIO
flange connector in stainless steel
Scale increments 1 to 10. Indication value is indicated for horizontally increasing flow.
015
G R
025
nominal
diameter
SK-
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
scale increments
5
6
7
indicating range
l/min H2O
3- 25
5- 40
10- 76
15- 195
3
5
10
15
4
7
14
23
5
9
19
29
7
10
22
35
8
13
27
41
9
15
30
46
10
18
36
59
10
14
21
44
79
20
28
63
118
25
40
76
195
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
232
Basic
Flow Indicator
Visoflow BL-...GK
sphere
GENERAL CHARACTERISITICS
9.1.
BL.
TECHNICAL DATA
stainless steel
BL-010GK
Type
G 1/4
G 3/8
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
G 1 1/2
PN
bar
BL-008GK
BL-010GK
BL-015GK
BL-020GK
BL-025GK
BL-040GK
media temperature
average pressue loss
full
visibility
Qmax.
recom.
l/min H2O
L
mm
H
mm
A
mm
B
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
0.3
0.3
0.3
2.5
4
11
1.5
1.5
1.5
5
8
23
4
8
12
25
40
60
76
76
76
89
89
118
67
67
67
78
78
95
42
42
42
42
42
50
60
60
60
60
60
77
28
28
28
45
45
62
12
16
14
18
18
30
0.8
0.7
0.7
1.4
1.3
2.5
16
16
16
16
16
16
max. 200C
0.2bar at Qmax.
MATERIALS
stainless steel 1.4436, 1.4410
PTFE
borosilikate
viton and klingersil C4400
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
BL-
008
008
010
015
020
025
040
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
oil
aggressive
liquids
G K
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
nominal
diameter
housing
sphere
dome
seal
basic type
specification
DN 8 - G1/4
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
DN 40 - G1 1/2
female thread
stainless steel
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
233
Basic
Honsberg at work
Monitoring and indicating air flow in painting
systems
In painting machines, compressed air is used as a carrier for the paint.
The constant air flow rate is decisive for the painting result. Honsberg
components are used for such applications.
234
Orifice
The technology
The dynamic orifice adapts the size of
the cross-section on the basis of flowdependent differential pressure, thus
limiting the flow rate to a defined
value.
Application
l Independent limitation of flow quantities without external power, for
example during distribution of central feed among consumers.
Advantages
l Can be installed in any position
l No power required
Contents
System description
236
Device descriptions
237
Technical data
Concept
Nominal diameter
10 - 25
Connection
female thread
PN
100 - 200
threshold
Adjustable
Materials
l Regulating
l Switching
235
Basic
System description
Device systems
Limiting liquid flow.
The medium produces a certain differential pressure at the orifice which
leads to the metal or elastomer elements being pushed into a spherical
cap. This effects a narrowing of the cross-section which limits the flow
to a fixed value.
There are spring-supported orifices available for complex tasks. These
move over a certain flow-dependent path and then rest against an end
stop. The advantage of such devices is the greater load capacity with
regard to the maximum differential pressure, which allows these devices
to be used for limiting even very large flow quantities.
KHK
These flow limiters [KH] are optionally available with a threshold fixture
which triggers a threshold contact at zero flow.
Type
Signal sensor
Full metal
KH
KM
WK
WP
WT
+
-
+
-
Differential
pressure
bar
2.5 - 30
1.5 - 10
2 - 10
1.0 - 10
1.5 - 8
Max.
pressure
bar
200
200
100
16
100
Differential pressure:
Flow rate as %
of regulating quantity
2.5 bar
30 bar
2.0 bar
10 bar
1.5 bar
10 bar
Max.
temperature
C
110
300
65
70
100
KM
elastomerere
WK
page
miscellaneous
aggressive
air/gas
oil
water
max. temperature C
on site metering
l
l
output signal
control
indication
connection
nominal diameter
type
metal
KH
200 120
200 120
l
l
200 300
200 300
100
65
100
65
16
70
241
242
15
15
WP
15
WT
15
100 100
238
239
240
Honsberg at work
Independent limitation of cooling systems in X-ray tubes
and nuclear magnetic resonance tomographs
X-ray tubes and nuclear magnetic resonance tomographs require precise
cooling systems to prevent the tubes from overheating.
Honsberg limiters guarantee independent limitation of the coolant quantity to
the required flow rate in the cooling units on the basis of differential pressure,
both in the main pipe and in the bypass.
l standard
m standard option
special option
237
Basic
Flow Regulator
Fluvastop KH-...GM/GK
orifice
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
12.1.
KH.
KH-015GM006
TECHNICAL DATA
Ms
VA
KHK-015GM006
Type
PN *
bar
G 1/2
G 1/2
KH.-015GM...
KH.-015GK...
200
1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9,10,12,16,20,25,30
1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9,10,12,16,20,25,30
150
* Max. differential pressure 30 bar !
differential pressure
tolerance
media temperature
regulation rate
l/min H2O
L
mm
SW
mm
weight
kg
59
59
27
27
0.2
0.2
2.5 - 30 bar
15% minimum 1l/min
max. 120C
flow rate %
of regulation rate
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
MATERIALS
body
orifice
magnet
spring
snap ring
seal
switch head
10
12
bar
KH.-015GM
brass Ms58
brass Ms58
bariumferrite
s.s. 1.4310
copper
NBR
POM
KH.-015GK
s.s. 1.4305
s.s. 1.4305
bariumferrite
s.s. 1.4310
s.s. 1.4310
viton
POM
MOUNTING POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
KHKHK-
015
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
1
brown
2
white
3
blue
Sonderoption
VARIO
M
K
001
...
030
basic type
specification
flow regulator
flow regulator with switch head
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
female thread
brass design
stainless steel design
[
[
[
[
[
S
[
regulation rate 001 - 030 l/min H2O
[
see table
[
0 special ranges
entrance/male thread
special thread
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
238
4
black
NOMENCLATURE
KHK- 015 G M 001
free
Basic
Flow Regulator
Fluvastop KM-...GM/GK
orifice
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
12.1.
KM.
KM-020GM016
VA
Ms
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
G 1/2
G 3/4
G 1/2
G 3/4
KM-015GM...
KM-020GM...
KM-015GK...
KM-020GK...
differential pressure
media temperature
regulation rate
l/min H2O
PN *
bar
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
42
50
42
27
36
27
10
14
10
50
36
14
0.13
0.30
0.13
0.30
200
1 - 16
4 - 30
200
200
1 - 16
200
4 -30
* Max. differential pressure16 bar !
1,5 - 10 bar
max. 300C
2
4
6
10 12 16 20 25 30 l/min
8
3
regulation rate 1
tolerance 0.2 0.2 0.4 0.4 0.5 0.5 0.7 0.7 1.2 1.2 1.5 1.5 l/min
flow rate %
of regulation rate
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
bar
MATERIALS
body
orifice
insert
KM-...GM
NOMENCLATURE
KM-...GK
brass Ms58
s.s. 1.4310
s.s. 1.4301
s.s. 1.4122
s.s. 1.4301
s.s. 1.4310
s.s. 1.4301
s.s. 1.4122
KM-
015
015
020
MOUNTING POSITION
G M
G
M
K
Special option
VARIO
001
001
...
030
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
0
METERING SUBSTANCES
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 20 - G3/4
female thread
brass design
stainless steel design
regulation rate 001 - 030 l/min H2O
see table
special ranges
entrance/female thread
exit/male thread
special thread
water
- Please indicate metering substance and regulation quantity with your order.
- With viscous liquids indicate viscosity, temperature and
metering substance (e.g. ISO VG68) (regulation rate on request)
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
239
Basic
Flow Regulator
Fluvastop WK-...GM/GK
orifice
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
12.1.
WK.
stainless brass
TECHNICAL DATA
WK-015GM012
Type
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
G 1/2
G 3/4
G1
WK-015GM...
WK-020GM...
WK-025GM...
WK-015GK...
WK-020GK...
WK-025GK...
differential pressure
tolerance
media temperature
PN *
bar
regulation rate
l/min H2O
L
mm
AF
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
40
40
60
40
40
60
30
36
46
30
36
46
12
12
20
12
12
20
0.18
0.18
0.70
0.18
0.18
0.70
100
3,5,6,8,10
100
6,8,10,12,15
100
6,8,10,12,15
100
3,5,6,8,10
100
6,8,10,12,15
100
6,8,10,12,15
* Max. differential pressure16 bar !
2 - 10 bar
15%
max. 65C
100
80
60
40
20
0
3
bar
MATERIALS
WK-...GM
body
insert
o-ring
spacer
NOMENCLATURE
brass Ms 58
POM
NBR
s.s. 1.4571
WK-...GK
s.s. 1.4305
POM
NBR
s.s. 1.4571
WK-
015
015
020
025
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
G M
M
K
Special option
VARIO
003
003
005
006
008
010
012
015
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
0
regulation rate
H2O
flow rate %
of regulation rate
120
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN 20 - G3/4
nominal diameter DN 25 - G1
female thread
brass design
stainless steel design
3 l/min
5 l/min
6 l/min
8 l/min
10 l/min
12 l/min
15 l/min
special ranges
entrance/female thread
exit/male thread
- Please indicate metering substance and regulation quantity with your order.
- With viscous liquids indicate viscosity, temperature and
metering substance (e.g. ISO VG68) (regulation rate on request)
All technical changes reserved
[BASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
240
Basic
Flow Regulator
Fluvastop WP-015GM
orifice
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
12.1.
WP.
WP-015GM050
TECHNICAL DATA
regulation rate
system pressure
differential pressure
tolerance
media temperature
storage temperature
weight
100
80
60
40
20
0
3 4
bar
MATERIALS
body
insert
NOMENCLATURE
brass
NBR
MOUNTING POSITION
WP-
015
015
G M
G
M
K
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
005
005
010
015
020
032
040
050
070
080
100
120
150
180
200
[
[
[
3
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
regulation rate
H2O
flow rate %
of regulation rate
120
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
female thread
brass design
stainless steel design
0.5 l/min
1.0 l/min
1.5 l/min
2 l/min
3.2 l/min
4 l/min
5 l/min
7 l/min
8 l/min
10 l/min
12 l/min
15 l/min
18 l/min
20 l/min
- Please indicate metering substance and regulation quantity with your order.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
241
Basic
Flow Regulator
Fluvastop WT-015GM
orfice
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
12.1.
WT.
WT-015GM050
TECHNICAL DATA
regulation rate
sysrem pressure
differential pressure
tolerance
media temperature
weight
flow rate %
of regulation rate
120
100
80
60
40
20
0
3 4
bar
MATERIALS
body
insert
NOMENCLATURE
brass Ms58 nickel plated
perbunan
MOUNTING POSITION
WT-
015
015
G M
G
050
050
075
135
[
[
[
[
[
[
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN 15 - G1/2
female thread
brass design
regulation rate 5.0 l/min H2O
regulation rate 7.5 l/min H2O
regulation rate 13.5 l/min H2O
METERING SUBSTANCES
- Please indicate metering substance and regulation quantity with your order.
- With viscous liquids indicate viscosity, temperature and
metering substance (e.g. ISO VG68) (regulation rate on request)
water
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
242
Level
The technology
Float
Magnetic-equipped float follows the level
in the guide tube and triggers a threshold contact or reed switch chain.
Sight glass
Optical display of the filling level of
a container
Contents
System description
Device systems
244
245
247
Application
Honsberg products in practical use 248
I
Device descriptions
249
Advantages
l Simple device structure
l Adaptation of the device to individual applications
l Threshold value or measured value sensor
Technical data
Concept
Nominal diameter
1/8 to 2
Connection
PN
5 - 40
Adjustable
yes
Materials
l Switching
l Indicating
l Metering
243
Basic
System description
Device system
Monitoring and metering levels using floats is a reliable method of
monitoring and metering filling levels in containers and apparatus.
Vertical installation
The level sensor is installed in the required length and with the required
number of contacts vertically in the container. The level moves a float
which is equipped with a magnet, and in this way activates the reed
contact which is hermetically sealed in the tube and triggers the threshold value.
Protection tube
(1) with basic disk
1 (2) stabilises level
indications in
extreme working
conditions.
244
Horizontal installation
In the case of horizontal devices the monitor is installed in the wall at
the same height of the level to be monitored. In this way different levels
can be monitored by different devices arranged in different positions.
The devices can be operated as make contact or break contact depending on their installation position.
Sight glass
Sight glasses [NA, NB, NBS, NG] are available for optical monitoring.
Make contact
Break contact
I
Functions and advantages
The advantage of the system is the versatility to individual applications by
choice of pipe length and the purely physical basis of the float operation.
It is important for the float to be of the correct weight which has to be
in relation to the density of the flow medium.
high
density
low
density
245
Basic
Metering
Single-float
technology
with surge
pipe
Full
Linearized graph of
tank level to resistance value
Monitoring
Multiple-float
technology
with surge
pipe
Max.
level
monitoring
Min.
level
monitoring
Max.
level
monitoring +
temperature
monitoring
Advantages:
Advantages:
Honsberg is an original equipment manufacturer for important machinery manufacturers and supplies level-monitoring devices for oil and
water as well as metering devices for fuel.
The monitoring devices work as minimum threshold level sensors and
produce a warning signal when the minimum level is reached whereas
the fuel sensors provide a continual level-dependent output which is
transferred to a display instrument in the cockpit.
Types
Length
Threshold value
Output signal
Optional
246
NRK [fuel]
NRW [water]
NROE [oil]
150 to 900 mm
min. and/or max.
Ohm
Temperature monitor, surge pipe
248
248
248
249
250
NMS-..HK
SB-..HM
12
105
NR
flange aluminium
male thread stainless steel
l
l
15
15
100
100
l
l
l
l
LC
m
m
20
40
105
105
l
l
l
l
RW-..HK
RWI-..PP
RWI-..PV
l
l
l
6
6
6
200
80
130
l
l
l
l
l
l
MW3/NW3
l
l
25
10
110
110
l
l
l
l
NW1
l
l
25
10
110
110
l
l
l
l
CWE
11
120
m
m
l
l
m
m
1-4 switch
1-4 switch
page
l
l
l
l
male
male
male
male
micellaneous
l
l
l
l
aggressive
oil
60
105
105
105
air/gas
water
5
15
40
12
on site metering
max. temperature C
plastic
stainless steel
stainless steel
stainless steel
output signal
thread
thread
thread
thread
control
l
l
l
l
connection
nominal diameter
type
float
NM-..HP
NM-..HK
252
254
256
257
257
258
259
260
MWI
l
l
NG
NBS
sight glass
NA
NB
infrared
NL
l standard
m standard option
special option
l
l
15
15
180
180
l
l
l
l
261
75
262
50
263
l
l
80
80
l
l
l
l
264
264
100
100
l
l
l
l
265
247
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix NM-...HK/HP
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
NM.
NM-007HP
TECHNICAL DATA
polypropylene
stainless steel
stainless steel
Type
Pg7
G 1/8 A
G 1/4 A
NM-007HP
NM-004HK2
NM-008HK
NM-004HK2
NM-008HK
liquid density
g/cm
media temperature
C
PN
bar
material
weight
g
0.80
0.70
0.66
max. 60C
max. 105C
max. 105C
5
15
40
PP / PA
1.4571
1.4571
40
60
130
NM-007HP
MOUNTING POSITION
NM-004HK2
NM-008HK
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch
wiring 0.225
n.c. or n.o. depending on installation position
cable 1,5 m
NM-007HP - 250 V AC 0,5 A 10 VA
NM-004HK2 - 300 V AC 0,5 A 50 VA
NM-008HK - 250 V AC 1,3 A 80 VA
protection class IP 65
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
NM-
water
007HP
007HP
004HK2
008HK
Z
Z
Z
Beispiel
Beschreibung
male thread Pg7
male thread G1/8A
male thread G1/4A
oil
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
248
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix NMS-004HM
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
NMS.
TECHNICAL DATA
Messing
NMS-004HM40
Type
G 1/8 A
G 1/8 A
G 1/8 A
NMS-004HM40
NMS-004HM47
NMS-004HM77
media temperature
NMS-004HM47
NMS-004HM77
liquid density
g/cm
PN
bar
L0
mm
L1
mm
D
mm
B
mm
weight
g
0.40
0.38
0.34
12
12
12
40
47
77
20
20
34
30
20
30
10
12
10
55
65
75
max. 105C
MATERIAL
body
float
nuts
brass Ms58
spansil
bronze / NMS-004HM47 stainless seel
MOUNTING POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch
wiring 0.225
n.c. or n.o. depending on installation position
cable 1.5 m
NMS-004HM40 - 300 V AC 0,5 A 70 VA
NMS-004HM47 - 300 V AC 0,5 A 70 VA
NMS-004HM77 - 250 V AC 1,3 A 80 VA
protection class IP 65
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
NMS-
water
004
004
H M
H
oil
40
40
47
77
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Beispiel
Beschreibung
male thread G1/8A
connection thread
brass
length 40 mm
length 47 mm
length 77 mm
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
249
Basic
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Level Switch
Nivofix SB-025HM
20.1.
SB.
top assembly
TECHNICAL DATA
SB-025HM0100
Type
PN
bar
liquid density
g/cm
L
mm
L1
mm
weight
kg
G1 A
SB-025HM0100
SB-025HM0200
SB-025HM0300
SB-025HM0400
SB-025HM0500
12
12
12
12
12
0.34
0.34
0.34
0.34
0.34
100
200
300
400
500
60
160
260
360
460
0.35
0.40
0.50
0.55
0.60
brass
tolerance
media temperature
5mm
max. 105C
MATERIALS
tube
gfloat
housing
brass Ms58
spansil
brass Ms58
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
250
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix SB-025HM
float
20.1.
SB.
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch - wiring 0.280 change over
220 V AC 0.5 A
60VA
plug DIN 43650-A
protection class IP 65
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
SB-
025HM
025HM
0100
0100
0200
0300
0400
0500
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
basic type
specification
socket thread G1 A brass - float spansil
tube length L= 100mm
tube length L= 200mm
tube length L= 300mm
tube length L= 400mm
tube length L= 500mm
special tube length
temperature 120C
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
251
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix NR-...HK/EA
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
NR.
aluminium
stainless
steel
TECHNICAL DATA
NR-120EA1000
Type
G2A
NR-050HK0250
NR-050HK0500
NR-050HK0750
NR-050HK1000
NR-120EA0250
NR-120EA0500
NR-120EA0750
NR-120EA1000
flange
media temperature
max. 100C
liquid density
g/cm
PN
bar
max. number of
switch contacts
(to order separately)
L
mm
weight
kg
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.8
15
15
15
15
15
15
15
15
2
3
4
4
2
3
4
4
250
500
750
1000
250
500
750
1000
1.3
1.4
1.6
1.7
1.0
1.1
1.3
1.4
NR-050HK...
NR-120EA...
MATERIALS
tube
flange
float
housing
NR-050HK
s.s. 1.4571
s.s. 1.4571
aluminium
NR-120EA
brass
aluminium
s.s. 1.4571
aluminium
252
Basic
float
Level Switch
Nivofix NR-...HK/EA
20.1.
NR.
ELECTRICAL DATA
See switch module.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
NR-
0250
050HK
050HK
120EA
0250
0500
0750
1000
Special option
VARIO
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
R
basic type
specification
socket thread G2A stainless steel
flange 120 aluminium
tube length L= 250mm
tube length L= 500mm
tube length L= 750mm
tube length L=1000mm
protection tube aluminium (flange design only)
special tube length up to 2500mm
combination flange and tube stainless steel
SWITCH MODULE
NR-000
4 contacts per
reed switch
wiring 0.225 n.o. or n.c.
cable gland Pg13,5
250 V AC , 1 A , 250 VA
protection class IP 65
180
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
253
Basic
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Level Transmiter
Nivofix LC-...HM/HK
20.1.
LC.
top assembly
selectable material combinations
stainless steel
brass
TECHNICAL DATA
LC-S45HM0250
Type
PN
bar
liguid density
g/cm
resolution
mm
G1 A
LC-S45HM0250
LC-S45HM0500
LC-S45HM0750
LC-S45HM1000
LC-S44HM1000
LC-S44HM1500
LC-S44HM2000
LC-K52HK0250
LC-K52HK0500
LC-K52HK0750
LC-K52HK1000
LC-K52HK1500
LC-K52HK2000
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
40
40
40
40
40
40
0.34
0.34
0.34
0.34
0.44
0.44
0.44
0.66
0.66
0.66
0.66
0.66
0.66
10
10
10
10
20
20
20
10
20
20
20
20
20
G1 1/2 A
G2 A
length tolerance
media temperature
option
4..20mA , 0..10V
locking plug
resistor
Ohm *
LC-K52HK0250
tolerance
Ohm
at max
0 - 1800
136
0 - 4300
186
0 - 1503
52
0 - 2055
64
0 - 2295
95
0 - 3543
121
0 - 4790
146
0 - 1500
130
0 - 4000
280
0 - 1647
83
0 - 2246
94
0 - 3493
120
0 - 4741
144
* +1000 Ohm series resistance
L
mm
L1
mm
weight
kg
250
500
750
1000
1000
1500
2000
250
500
750
1000
1500
2000
190
440
690
940
930
1430
1930
160
510
690
910
1410
1910
0.5
0.6
0.6
0.7
0.7
0.8
.08
1.0
1.0
1.0
1.1
1.1
1.1
5mm
max. 105C resistance output
max. 85C 4..20mA, 0..10V
option
4..20mA , 0..10V
plug DIN 43650-A
option
resistor
locking plug
standard
resistor
plug DIN 43650-A
MATERIALS
tube
float
housing
LC-S4.HM
Ms58
Spansil
Ms58
LC-K52HK
LC-S45
LC-S44
254
LC-K52
Basic
Level Transmiter
Nivofix LC-...HM/HK
float
ELECTRICAL DATA
24 V DC
50 mA
resistance value see table 'technical data'
potentiometer resistance 500-2000
protection class IP 65
option:
20.1.
LC.
locking plug M12x1 - 4pole
1kOhm
1kOhm
1
+
4..20mA 2-wire
2
C
3
ground
1
brow n
+
4..20mA 3-wire
4
black
C
3
blue
ground
0..10V
+(10-30VDC)
output
+(10-30VDC)
output
0V
+(10-30VDC)
output
0VDC
1
1
brown
2
4
black
1
1
brown
2
4
black
3
3
blue
1
1
brown
2
4
black
3
3
blue
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
LC-
S45HM
S45HM
S44HM
K52HK
0250 W B
0250
0500
0750
1000
1500
2000
W
Z
T
V
B
S
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
R
R
Z
R
R
PRINCIPLE
OUT
3
2
1
plate
reed contact
resistor
float
magnet
Switching sequence:
COMBINATIONS
pipe
GND +
basic type
specification
socket thread G1 A brass - float Spansil
socket thread G1 1/2 A brass - float Spansil
socket thread G2 A stainless steel
tube length L= 250mm
tube length L= 500mm
tube length L= 750mm
tube length L= 1000mm
tube length L= 1500mm
tube length L= 2000mm
resistor
4..20mA output (2-wire)
4..20mA output (3-wire)
0..10V output
plug DIN 43650-A
connection for locking plug M12x1 4-pole
special tube length
temperature 120C
reed 1 switches
reed 1+2 switches
reed 2 switches
reed 2+3 switches
omni-LC
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)..20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
Flex-LC
switch- or frequency output
0..10V oder 4..20mA
PNP, NPN
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
255
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix RW-...HK
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISITICS
20.1.
RW.HK
TECHNICAL DATA
RW-015HKS
pressure
media temperature
weight
liquid density
RW-015HKL
PN 5 bar
max. 120C
110g
0.75 g/cm
PN 6 bar
max. 200C
120 g
0,70 g/cm
MATERIALS
RW-015HKS
body
float
MOUNTING POSITION
RW-015HKL
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch
wiring
plug design
lead design
protection class
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
RW-
water
015
015
H K S
H
oil
S
L
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
basic type
specification
connection thread 1/2 BSPT
socket thread
stainless steel
plug (only RW-015)
leads
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
256
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix RWI-016PP/PV
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
RWI.P
Compression gland
Male thread M16x1,5 polypropylen/PVDF
RWI-016PP
TECHNICAL DATA
polypropylen
PVDF
Type
M16x1,5
M16x1,5
RWI-016PP
RWI-016PV
liquid density
g/cm
PN
bar
media temperature
max C
weight
g
0.6
0.75
3
6
90
130
75
75
assembly internally
hole diameter 16.5
MATERIALS
RWI-016PP
body
float
seal
RWI-016PV
polypropylen
polypropylen
viton
PVDF
PVDF
viton
MOUNTING POSITION
assembly externally
hole diameter 23
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch
wiring 0.225 n.c. or n.o. depending on installation position
cable 0.5 m
250 V AC 0.5 A 50VA
protection class IP 65
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
RWI-
016
P
P
water
P
P
V
oil
RWI-016PPF
version faston clamp
K
F
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
R
basic type
specification
compression gland
polypropylen PP
PVDF
cable
faston clamp
seal silikon
change over 175 VAC 0.25 A 3VA
RWI-020HM
with brass connection
male thrtead G3/4A
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
257
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix MW3/NW3-020HM/HK
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
MW3/NW3
TECHNICAL DATA
brass
stainless steel
NW3-020HM
Type
G 3/4 A
G 3/4 A
MW3 / NW3-020HM
MW3 / NW3-020HK
media temperature
liquid density
g/cm
PN
bar
L
mm
weight
kg
0.7
0.9
25
10
72
76
0.35
0.35
max. 110C
-HM20
spansil
MATERIALS
housing
socket
wetted parts
float
magnet
seal
MW3/NW3-020HM
MW3/NW3-020HK
INSTALLATION POSITION
Type
MW3 -020HK
lliquid density
1g/cm
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
design stainless steel
MW3/NW3-020HK
for aggressive liquids
option
ball PVDF
ELECTRICAL DATA
MW3
micro switch
wiring 0.374 change over
250 V AC 5 A
plug DIN 43650-A
protection class IP 65
NW3
reed switch
wiring 0.225 n.c. or n.o. depending
on installation position
230 V AC 1 A 50 VA
plug DIN 43650-A
protection class IP 65
NOMENCLATURE
MW3-
oil
-020HK
stainless
steel
020
MW3NW3-
Special option
VARIO
H M
H
Z
Z
Z
M Z
K Z
0
Beispiel
Beschreibung
micro switch
reed switch
socket thread G3/4A
brass design
stainless steel design
contact for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
float ball PVDF
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
258
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix NW1-020HM/HK
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
NW1
TECHNICAL DATA
brass
stainless steel
NW1-020HM
Type
G 3/4 A
G 3/4 A
NW1-020HM
NW1-020HK
media temperature
liquid density
g/cm
PN
bar
L
mm
weight
kg
0.7
0.9
25
10
74
80
0.35
0.35
max. 110C
NW1-020HM
spansil
MATERIALS
housing
socket
wetted parts
float
magnet
seal
NW1-020HM
Ms58
Ms58
stainless steel
1.4310 ; 1.4571
spansil
oxyd 300
NBR
NW1-020HK
NW1-020HK
stainless
steel
option
ball PVDF
INSTALLATION POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch
wiring 0.225 n.c. or n.o. depending
on installation position
230 V AC 1 A 50 VA
cable 1.5m
protection class IP 65
METERING SUBSTANCES
020
H M
H
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
MW1-
Programme option
BASIC
Special option
VARIO
Z
Z
Z
M
K
A
R
0
Beispiel
Beschreibung
socket thread G3/4A
brass design
stainless steel design
switch ATEX
(product information 92.1.U1)
special cable length
float ball PVDF
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
259
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix CWE-025HM
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
CWE.
CWE-025HM
TECHNICAL DATA
brass
Type
R1"
CWE-025HM
media temperature
liquid density
g/cm
PN
bar
L
mm
weight
kg
0.9
11
232
0.8
max. 85C
MATERIALS
socket
wetted parts
float
bellow
cap
plate
brass Ms58
brass Ms58
policarbonate
tombak
ABS
steel zinc coating
MOUNTING POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
red
blue
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
CWE-
025
H M
H
water
Special option
VARIO
Z
Z
0
basic type
specification
connection thread DN25 - R1"
brass design
gold contacts 125 V AC / 1 A
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
260
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix MWI-025HM
Float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
MWI.
TECHNICAL DATA
brass
MWI-025HM
Type
G1A
MWI-025HM
media temperature
liquid density
g/cm
PN
bar
hysteresis
mm
weight
kg
0.7
15
20 - 30
1.3
max. 180C
MATERIALS
housing
float
brass Ms58
stainless steel 1.4571
MOUNTING POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
2 micro switch
wiring 0.392 change over
250 V AC 5 A
cable gland Pg 9
protection class IP 65
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
MWI-
water
025
H M
H
Z
Z
basic type
specification
socket thread G1A
brass design
oil
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
261
Basic
Level Switch
Nivofix NG-...GA
float
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
20.1.
NG.
NG-015GA1
TECHNICAL DATA
aluminium
media temperature
switch point
NPT
Type
1/2"NPT
NG-015GA1
NG-015GA2
liquid density
g/cm
PN
bar
weight
kg
0.8
>0.8
8
8
0.8
0.9
max. 75 C
55mm middle thread entrance
ON (NG-015GA1)
NG-015GA2 see sketch
MATERIALS
body
float
glass
seal
aluminium
stainless steel
acrylic
NBR
MOUNTING POSITION
NG-015GA2
NG-015GA1
ELECTRICAL DATA
reed switch
leads 0.5 metre
120 V AC 0.4 A
140 V AC 0.2 A
24 V DC 1.0 A
120 V DC 0.4 A
220 V DC 0.2 A
protection class IP 65
2
1
NG-015GA1
wiring 0.372
METERING SUBSTANCES
wiring 0.292
NOMENCLATURE
NG-
water
NG-015GA2
015
G A
G
oil
1
1
2
Z
Z
Z
Z
basic type
specification
female thread
aluminium
1 switch point
2 switch points
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
262
Basic
Level Indicator
Nivofix NBS-010HM
20.2.
NBS.
NBS-010HM080
TECHNICAL DATA
media temperature
weight
max. 50C
95g (NBS-010HM040)
195g (NBS-010HM300)
length 40-200
vent hole
in the cover
MATERIALS
body
tube
sight ring
rod
float
buffer
brass
natural glass
PVC
acrylic
spansil
NBR
MOUNTING POSITION
I
NOMENCLATURE
NBS-
010
010
H M
H
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
Special option
VARIO
040
040
060
080
100
125
150
200
250
300
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
basic type
specification
connection thread G3/8A
socket thread
brass
length 40 mm
length 60 mm
length 80 mm
length 100 mm
length 125 mm
length 150 mm
length 200 mm
length 250 mm
length 300 mm
length 50,70,90,175 and >300 mm
connection thread G1/2A
oil
All technical changes reserved
ZBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
263
Basic
Level Indicator
Nivofix NA- / NB-010HM
sight glass
GENERAL CHARACTERISITCS
21.1.
NA./NB.
NA-010HM125
TECHNICAL DATA
media temerature
weight
max. 80C
90 g (NA-010HM040)
130 g (NA-010HM300)
NAlength 40-200
NB-010HM125
NBlength 40-200
vent hole
in the cover
MATERIALS
body
tube
brass
natural glass
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
NANANB-
010
010
H M
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
Special option
VARIO
040
040
060
080
100
125
150
200
250
300
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
basic type
specification
straight connect
angled connect
connection thread G3/8A
socket thread
brass
length 40 mm
length 60 mm
length 80 mm
length 100 mm
length 125 mm
length 150 mm
length 200 mm
length 250 mm
length 300 mm
length 50,70,90,175 and >300 mm
connection thread G1/2A
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
264
Basic
Level Switch
Nivolock NL-015HS/HK
infrared
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
22.1.
NL.
NL-015AKT05
TECHNICAL DATA
Type
1/2" NPT
NL-015HST05
NL-015HST24
NL-015HSN05
NL-015HSN24
NL-015HKT05
NL-015HKT24
NL-015HKN05
NL-015HKN24
steel
NPT
s.s
1/2" NPT
input
power
VDC
5
24
5
24
5
24
5
24
function
PN
bar
media
temperature
C *
repeat
accuracy
weight
g
160
-40 .. 100
1mm
75
160
-40 .. 100
1mm
75
160
-40 .. 100
1mm
75
160
-40 .. 100
1mm
75
receiv er
receiv er
pris m
LED
LED
light
los t in
liquid
MATERIALS
body
glass
NL-015HS.
NL-015HK.
stainless steel
fused glass
Basic
Level Switch
Nivolock NL-015HS/HK
infrared
ELECTRICAL DATA
current consumentation
input power
output
w hite
blac k
ca. 45 mA
5 VDC or 24 VDC (optional 12 VDC)
NPN open collector
transistor output whit 10K pull up resistor
may sink 18 mA max.
300mm
IP 64
wires
protection class
MOUNTING POSITION
red
22.1.
output
0 V DC
load / 18mA max.
12 V DC or 5V DC
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
oil
NOMENCLATURE
NL-
015
015
HS
HS
HK
T
N
05
12
24
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
Z
basic type
specification
male thread 1/2" NPT
connection thread steel nickel plated
connection thread stainless steel
wet - signal when sensor has no contact to liquid
dry - signal when sensor has contact to liquid
12 VDC
24 VDC
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
266
NL.
Why to use a
Basic
level instrument
IP67
versatility
wide application
combination of controls
in one instrument
adjustment to low
densities
267
Where to use a
Basic
level instrument
Market segments
l Earth movers
l Air conditioners
l Motor technology
Application
l Level control of water, oil and gasoline tanks in construction
machines
l Level control of condensate
l Level control of food oils
268
Temperature
The technology
A bimetal element is triggered when
a pre-set temperature threshold is reached.
Contents
Application
System description
270
Device descriptions
271
Advantages
l Simple yes/no monitoring
l Extremely accurate temperature measurement
Technical data
Concept
Built-in housing
Connection:
PN
16 - 200
threshold, 4[0]..20 mA
Adjustable
yes
Materials
l Switching
l Metering
269
Basic
System description
Device system
Sturdy temperature monitors in brass or stainless steel housings are
available for monitoring and metering temperature. Thanks to the
stub-connection thread these can be installed directly in the pipeline.
Bimetal
A bimetal switch with a jump characteristic closes or opens when the
pre-set temperature has been reached and triggers a threshold signal.
Diaphragm
A temperature probe filled with an expansion fluid is used for devices
with an infinitely variable switching point that can be selected via a
scale.
As temperature increases this metering material expands and acts on a
spring-supported diaphragm which triggers a contact. A spring characteristic is changed via the setting, thus influencing the triggering of the
threshold value. Greater preliminary tension makes a greater triggering
force necessary which in turn occurs at a higher temperature value.
Platinum resistance sensor
The temperature transmitters comprise a temperature sensor
PT100/1000 resistance sensor which shows good dynamic behaviour
thanks to the small sensor diameter. The temperature-dependent
change in resistance is transformed into a linear output signal
4[0]..20 mA by the downstream electronics.
270
control
measurement
ETS
ETSD
l
l
l
l
page
l
l
miscellaneous
max. temperature C
on site metering
output signal
l
aggressive
gas/air
oil
TR
100 140
100 140
water
l
l
indication
control
nominal diameter
type
TF1
272
16
145
25
80
25
80
1-2 switch
273
274
differential
276
Honsberg at work
Temperature monitoring of pumps in
high-pressure cleaners
l standard
m standard option
special option
271
Basic
Temperature Switch
Thermofix TF1-...M/K
bimetal
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
30.1.
TF1.
TECHNICAL DATA
TF1-040M015HS
Type
PN
bar
switch value
C in increments to 10
brass
40 - 130
G 1/2 A
100
TF1-...M015H..
40 - 130
stainless steel G 1/2 A
TF1-...K015H..
100
Sensor has to be fully wetted. Switch value is indicated for increasing temperature 2K/min.
tolerance
media Temperature
hysteresis
K
weight
kg
10 - 20
10 - 20
0.12
0.12
10K
switch value + 50C
MATERIALS
body
plug
TF1-...M015H..
TF1-...K015H..
Ms58
PA6.6
1.4305
PA6.6
MOUNTING POSITION
Sensor has to be fully
wetted!
ELECTRICAL DATA
wiring 0.212
n.o.
250 V AC 10 A
plug DIN 43650-A
protection class IP 65
METERING SUBSTANCES
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
TF1-
water
wiring 0.214
n.c.
040
040
...
130
oil
M
K
015
015
020
Programme option
BASIC
basic type
specification
S
O
Z
R
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
R
brass design
stainless steel design
connection thread G1/2A
connection thread G3/4A (36 AF)
socket thread
wiring 0.212 n.o.
wiring 0.214 n.c.
diode integrated in plug
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
272
Basic
Temperature Switch
Thermofix TR-015HM
diaphragm
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
30.1.
TR.
TR-015HM1
TECHNICAL DATA
adjustable range
adjustment
tolerance
pressure
media temperature
ambient Temperature
hysteresis
weight
TR-015HM1
externally adjustable
50 - 130C
TR-015HM2
externally adjustable
internally adjustable
35 - 95C
50 - 130C
in 5C increments
5K
PN 16 bar
max. 145C
max. 80C
8K
TR-015HM1
5K
TR-015HM2
TR-015HM1
0.3kg
TR-015HM2
0.5kg
TR-015HM1
TR-015HM2
MATERIALS
body
immersion sleeve
probe
cap
MOUNTING POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
micro switch
wiring 0.342 change over
250 V AC 15 A (8 A inductive)
cable gland Pg13.5
protection class IP 43
J
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
TR-
water
gas/air
015
015
H M
H
oil
1
2
Programme option
BASIC
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
basic type
specification
connection thread R1/2"
socket thread
brass design
1 contact
2 contacts
length of pobe 200mm switch range on request
probe stainless steel 1.4301
protection class IP 54
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
273
Basic
platinum resistance sensor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Temperature Transmitter
ETS
31.1.
ETS.
TECHNICAL DATA
range
option
accuracy
dynamics ()
0..100C
temperature <0C
1% FS
5s
operating pressure
max. 25 bar
operating temperature max. 80C
(with goose-neck max. 250C)
operating temperature 0..80C
of the electronic
weight
0.2kg
recess
DIN 3852 Bl.2
MOUNTING
The sensors are installed with appropriate sealing (Teflon
tape or triplex etc.) in a connection piece or a T-piece of
the pipe. To tighten the sensor please use only the
hexagonal key provided (AF27mm). The tip of the probe
should be completely surronded by the medium when in
use. Please avoid installing in high temperature sites
where the sensor housing is exposed to the convected
heat of the pipe.
After sealing, you can turn the sensor into the correct
cable input position. An over turn security limits the turn
range to nearly 360.
MATERIALS
temperature probe
other materials
274
Basic
Temperature Transmitter
ETS
31.1.
ETS.
ELECTRICAL DATA
10..30 V DC 10%
4..20 mA
700W at 24 V (100W at
10V - 1K at 30V, linear to
the operation voltage )
for locking plug
M12x1, 4pole
or plug DIN 43650-A
IP 67 looking plug
IP 65 plug DIN 43650-A
supply voltage
analogue output
max. load
connection
protection class
MOUNTING POSITION
sensor
1
2
brow n
+ (10-30VDC)
w hite
output
Before carrying out the electrical installation, make sure that the
supply voltage corresponds to the data specification.
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
air/gasses
oil
aggressive liquids
NOMENCLATURE
ETS-
015
S
B
050
100
150
200
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
R
basic type
specification
range 0 - 100 C
range 0 - 250C only with goose-neck
probe stainles steel 1.4571
connection G1/2A
connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
plug DIN 43650-A
probe length 50 mm
probe length 100 mm
probe length 150 mm
probe length 200 mm
with goose-neck
ACCESSORY
COMBINATIONS
omni-T
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)...20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
PU-
K
KB04
PU-
02
02
05
10
S G
G
W
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
basic type
specification
ready-made cable
self makable cable 4-pole
material PUR
length 2 m
length 5 m
length 10 m
moulded-on plug
straight plug
angled plug 90
Flex-T
switch- or frequency output
0..10V or 4..20mA
PNP, NPN
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
275
Basic
platinum resistance sensor
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
35.1.
ETSD
ETSD.
TECHNICAL DATA
differential
temperature
accuracy
transient time
max. pressure
operating temperature
for electronics
measurement range
T1
measurement range
T2
weight
0.45kg
CHARACTERISTIC CURVES
4
0
-25 -20
Typ B
20 25
T1-T2/K
mA
21
20
MOUNTING
3.6 mA
4
0
20 21.25
MATERIALS
temperature probe
other materials
T1-T2/K
By means of the enclosed Sikurit seals the sensors are tightened into the T
piece of the pipe. Please only use the hexagonal head for tightening! Take
care to locate the tip of the sensing device fully into the flow area and avoid
direct contact to pipe wall. Accordingly the upper part of the sensor with the
plug connectors can be turned to any position in order to orientate proper
with the cable connectors.
276
Basic
platinum resistance sensor
ELECTRICAL DATA
supply voltage
analogue output
reverse polarity proof
35.1.
ETSD
ETSD.
15..30 V DC
4..20 mA (2-wire)
yes up to 25V (pin 1..4)
up to 40V (pin 1 and 2)
yes
plug DIN 43650-A
IP 65
T2
MOUNTING POSITION
T1
4..20mA
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
air/gasses
oil
aggressive liquids
NOMENCLATURE
ETSD1ETSD1-
ETSD2ETSD2-
020
030
050
K 050
K
028
029
045
050
100
150
200
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
028
029
045
050
100
150
200
A
B
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
basic type
specification
reference temperature sensor T1
difference 0 K corresponds with 4mA
difference 20 K corresponds with 20mA
other ranges on request
difference 30 K corresponds with 20mA
difference 50 K corresponds with 20mA
material medium contact stainless steel 1.4571
sensor length 28 mm
sensor length 29.6 mm
sensor length 45 mm
sensor length 50 mm
sensor length 100 mm
sensor length 150 mm
sensor length 200 mm
characteristic curve type A
characteristic curve type B
option goose-neck
basic type
specification
reference temperature sensor T2
material medium contact stainless steel 1.4571
sensor length 28 mm
sensor length 29.6 mm
sensor length 45 mm
sensor length 50 mm
sensor length 100 mm
sensor length 150 mm
sensor length 200 mm
For a complete temperature difference test station, sensor ETSD1 and ETSD2 must be ordered !
Attention! Use ETSD1 and ETSD2 with pairing serial number only.
ACCESSORIES
display connects with switch point GIA-0420VO product information 91.1.GIA.VO
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
277
Why to use a
Basic
temperature instrument
Where to use a
Basic
temperature instrument
Market segments
l Pumps
l Gears
l Lubrication
l Water circuits
Application
l Overheat protection in pumps
l Maximal temperature control in gears
l Continuous temperature monitoring in machine tools
278
Pressure
The technology
A piston moves dependent on pressure
and transfers this movement to adjustable
contacts.
Contents
Application
System description
280
Device descriptions
281
l Pressure transmitters take over complex metering tasks in pressure management and processes e.g. pressure-dependent valve
control.
Advantages
l Tried and tested technology in pressure monitoring and material
l Direct evaluation of contact and sensor signals
Technical data
Concept
built-in housing
Connection
screw-in thread
PN
0.3 - 600
Adjustable
yes
Materials
l Switching
l Metering
279
Basic
System description
Device system
Sturdy devices made of brass and stainless steel are available for monitoring and metering pressure and are installed directly into the pipework
thanks to a stub-connection thread. Pressure is applied to a diaphragm
or a piston in the case of the higher pressure ranges, which move a
certain defined path against spring force. This leads to a switch being
triggered when the pre-set threshold has been reached.
Pressure transmitters work according to the tried and trusted system
of strain gauge with piezoresistive sensor structure. Integrated linearized electronics produce pressure-related linear outputs of 4[0]..20 mA.
Brass and stainless steel materials allow possible applications even with
critical metering materials.
280
60
60
60
PI
600
VP
l
l
MD
nozzle
PS
EPS
EPS1
EDP1
control
measurement
miscellaneous
30
300
300
aggressive
l
l
l
3
3
3
l
l
l
3
3
3
60
20
20
60
60
l
l
3
3
vacuum
vavuum
285
0,3
60
differential
286
page
l
l
l
water
gas/air
max. temperature C
PM
oil
on site metering
60
60
60
output signal
control
30
300
300
indication
nominal diameter
l
l
l
type
PH
282
3
282
3
284
200 125
600
80
288
400
80
290
400
85
287
differential
292
Honsberg at work
Dosing powdered material in printing machines
In printing machines, the printed sheets
are covered with a fine layer of powder to
prevent them sticking to one another
during stacking. The powder material is
sprayed by an air carrier, whereby the
pressure ratios are decisive for the homogeneity and thickness of the powder layer.
In this process, Honsberg PM pressure
switches are responsible for homogenous
pressure data in the 0.8 bar range and a
permissible tolerance of 0.1 bar
l standard
m standard option
special option
Powder
container
281
Basic
Pressure Switch
Mikropond PH / PM-...M/K/S
diaphragm / piston
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
40.1.
PH./PM.
PM-002K004HS
PH-002M004HS
TECHNICAL DATA
brass
Type
PN
bar
80
P.-002M004H.
P.-010M004H.
80
300
R1/8"
P.-020S004H.
P.-050S004H.
300
P.-080S004H.
300
P.-150S004H.
300
R1/8"
P.-002K004H.
80
80
P.-010K004H.
150
P.-020K004H.
P.-050K004H.
150
P.-080K004H.
150
P.-150K004H.
150
Adjustable range is indicated for increasing pressure.
stainless steel
steel
R1/8"
media temperature
adjustable range
bar (rel.)
tolerance
(25C) bar
hysteresis
(25C) bar
operation
principle
weight
kg
0.15- 2
2 - 10
10 - 20
20 - 50
50 - 80
50 - 150
0.15- 2
2 - 10
10 - 20
20 - 50
50 - 80
50 - 150
0.2
0.3
0.4
1.0
2.0
5.0
0.2
0.3
0.4
1.0
2.0
5.0
0.15
0.2
0.3
0.8
5.5
10
0.15
0.2
0.3
0.8
5.5
10
diaphragm
0.08
diaphragm
0.08
piston
diaphragm
0.08
max. 60C
PM-
PH-
MATERIALS
body
diaphragm
piston
spring
cap /Typ PM
cap /Typ PH
piston
P.-002M to
P.-010M
brass
NBR
s.s. 1.4310
NBR
nylon
P.-020S to
P.-150S
steel
NBR
NBR
s.s. 1.4310
NBR
nylon
P.-...K..
s etting screw
protec ted by c ap
stainless steel
NBR
NBR
s.s. 1.4310
NBR
nylon
282
Basic
Pressure Switch
Mikropond PH / PM-...M/K/S
diaphragm / piston
ELECTRICAL DATA
wiring 0.212
n.o.
mechanical switch
48 V AC 0.5 A (0.2A inductive)
Typ PM- : plug 6.3 DIN 46224 form A
protection class IP 54
Typ PH- : induction clamp
protection class IP 65
P.-...S
MOUNTING POSITION
002
010
020
050
080
150
M
S
K
wiring 0.214
n.c.
P.-...O
water
gas/air
oil
Attention!
Do not use steel
body for water
004
004
H S
S
O
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
3
adjustable range
PMPH-
002
PH./PM.
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
PM-
40.1.
basic type
specification
pressure switch with rubber cap
pressure switch with plastic cap
0.15 - 2 bar (rel.)
2 - 10 bar (rel.)
10 - 20 bar (rel.)
20 - 50 bar (rel.)
50 - 80 bar (rel.)
50 - 150 bar (rel.)
brass design (only 2 to 10 bar)
steel design (only 20 to 150 bar)
stainless steel design
connection thread R1/8"
socket thread
wiring 0.212 n.o.
wiring 0.214 n.c.
mebran viton
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
283
Basic
Pressure Switch
Mikropond PI-...A
diaphragm / piston
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
40.1.
PI.
TECHNICAL DATA
R
PI-300A008H
PN
bar
Type
adjustable range
bar (rel.)
PI-005A004H
60
100
PI-010A004H
PI-025A004H
100
PI-080A004H
150
R1/4"
PI-150A008H
600
600
PI-300A008H
Adjustable range is indicated for increasing pressure.
aluminum
R1/8"
media temperature
hysteresis
tolerance
(25C) bar
operation
principle
H1
mm
H2
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
0.1
0.2
0.5
1.0
7.0
7.0
diaphragm
44
75
10
0.10
piston
46
78
12
0.22
0.2 - 5
0.5 - 10
10 - 25
25 - 80
30 - 150
150 - 300
external setting
screw
max. 60C
<30% from switch value
MATERIALS
aluminium
NBR
brass
stainless steel 1.4310
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
ELECTRICAL DATA
mechanical switch
wiring 0.280 change over
250 V AC 3A (2A inductive)
plug DIN 43650-A
protection class IP 65
oil
gas/air
005
005
010
025
080
150
300
NOMENCLATURE
PI-
water
004
004
008
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
adjustable range
body
diaphragm
piston
spring
basic type
specification
0,2 - 5 bar (rel.)
0,5 - 10 bar (rel.)
10 - 25 bar (rel.)
25 - 80 bar (rel.)
30 - 150 bar (rel.)
150 - 300 bar (rel.)
aluminium
connection thread R1/8"
connection thread R1/4"
socket thread
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
284
Basic
Pressure Switch
Mikropond VP-900K/S
diaphragm
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
40.1.
VP.
TECHNICAL DATA
steel
stainless steel
VP-900S004HS
Type
PN
bar
adjustable range
mbar
tolerance
(25C)
mbar
hysteresis
(25C)
mbar
weight
kg
R1/8"
R1/8"
VP-900S004H.
VP-900K004H.
20
20
200 - 900
200 - 900
50
50
20
20
0.07
0.07
media temperature
s etting sc rew
protected by c ap
max. 60C
MATERIALS
body
diaphragm
spring
cap
VP-900S004H.
steel
NBR
s.s. 1.4310
nylon
VP-900K004H.
stainless steel
NBR
s.s. 1.4310
nylon
MOUNTING POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
wiring 0.212
n.o.
mechanical switch
48 V AC 0.5 A (0.2A inductive)
induction clamp
protection class IP 65
wiring 0.214
n.c.
VP-...S
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
VP-
water
oil
gas/air
Attention!
Do not use steel
body for water
VP-...O
900
900
A
S
K
004
004
H S
S
O
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
basic type
specification
adjustable range 200 - 900 mbar
steel design
stainless steel design
connection thread R1/8"
socket thread
wiring 0.212 n.o.
wiring 0.214 n.c.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
285
Basic
diaphragm
GENERAL CHARACTERICS
40.1.
MD.
TECHNICAL DATA
DN
MD-006P006T
Type
PN
bar
adjustable range
mbar (rel.)
hysteresis
mbar
weight
kg
0.1 - 0.15
0.2 - 0.30
0.2 - 0.35
0.30
0.25
0.25
ABS
MD-003P006T
0.15
0.2 - 3
0.3
0.4 - 6
MD-006P006T
MD-010P006T
0.3
1.0 - 10
Adjustable range is indicated for increasing pressure and vertical installation.
6
media temperature
tolerance
max. 80C
10%
of selected switch value
MD-003P006T
MD-006P006T
MD-010P006T
MATERIALS
body
diaphragm
ABS
NBR
MOUNTING POSITION
ELECTRICAL DATA
METERING SUBSTANCES
NOMENCLATURE
MD-
gas/air
003
003
006
010
006
006
\
\
\
\
\
\
basic type
specification
adjustable range 0.2 - 3 mbar (rel.)
adjustable range 0.4 - 6 mbar (rel.)
adjustable range 1.0 - 10 mbar (rel.)
ABS
nominal diameter DN 6
nozzle
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
286
Basic
Pressure Transmitter
Mikropond PS-...K008H
thick film
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
41.1.
PS.
TECHNICAL DATA
PS-006K008H
Type
PN
bar
measuring range
bar (rel.)
weight
kg
G 1/4 A
PS-006K008H
PS-010K008H
PS-016K008H
PS-025K008H
PS-040K008H
PS-100K008H
18
30
48
75
120
200
0- 6
0 - 10
0 - 16
0 - 25
0 - 40
0 - 100
0.15
0.15
0.15
0.15
0.15
0.15
media temperature
tolerance
hysteresis
repeatabiltiy
temperature compens.
delay
max. 125C
0.5%
<0.2%
<0.5%
<0.02%/K
<3ms
MATERIALS
body
Please use the six-angular area to install the sensor into the socket.
Maximum torque 100Nm
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
ELECTRICAL DATA
supply
voltage deviation
nominal voltage
burden
connection
protection class
NOMENCLATURE
PS-
water
oil
gas/air
11.5..30 V DC
<0.02%/V
24V DC voltage peak
4..20mA
may not be surpassed
(U-11.5V)/0.02A
plug DIN 43650-A 1(+) and 2(-)
IP 65
006
006
010
016
025
040
100
008
008
Special option
VARIO
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
5
range
1.4305
basic type
specification
0 - 6 bar
0 - 10 bar
0 - 16 bar
0 - 25 bar
0 - 40 bar
0 - 100 bar
stainless steel 1.4305
male thread G1/4A
socket thread
male thread G1/2A
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
287
Basic
diaphragm
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Pressure Transmitter
EPS
41.1.
EPS.
TECHNICAL DATA
measurement
ranges
relative pressure
overload limit
(bar)
options
accuracy
reproducibility
operating temp.
for electronics
operating
temperature
weight
overload
range
4
0- 1
10
0 - 2,5
24
0- 6
40
0 - 10
100
0 - 25
240
0 - 60
400
0 - 100
600
0 - 250
600
0 - 400
additional measurement ranges
absolute pressure metering
(low limit 10mbar abs.)
1% / of 60C 0,02% /C
0.5%
0..80C
MOUNTING
The sensors are screwed into a sleeve or a T-piece in the
pipework using a suitable sealing material (Teflon tape,
Sikurite seal, etc.). The mounting of the sensor should not
cause any significant change of cross-section in the pipe
system. When tightening the sensor, be sure to only use
the proper hexagonal wrench (27mm AF). Avoid points of
installation subject to high pressure shocks (see overload
limit).
After sealing the sensor can be turned into the correct
position for the cable connection. A mechanical block
limits the total range turnable of 360.
MATERIALS
pressure transducer
other materials
288
Basic
Pressure Transmitter
EPS
diaphragm
41.1.
EPS.
ELECTRICAL DATA
supply voltage
analogue output
max. load
10..30 V DC 10%
4..20 mA
700 at 24 V (100 at
10V - 1K at 30V, linear to
the operation voltage )
for locking plug
M12x1, 4pole
or plug DIN 43650-A
IP 67 looking plug
IP 65 plug DIN 43650-A
connection
protection class
sensor
1
2
brow n
+ (10-30VDC)
w hite
output
Before carrying out the electrical installation, make sure that the
supply voltage corresponds to the data specification!
It is recommended to use shielded cable < 30 m, supply lines < 10 m
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
air/gasses
oil
aggressive liquids
NOMENCLATURE
006 R K 015 S
006
025
060
100
250
400
R
A
015
S
B
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
T
\
\
\
\
T
range
EPS-
basic type
specification
0 - 6 bar
0 - 25 bar
0 - 60 bar
0 - 100 bar
0 - 250 bar
0 - 400 bar
relative pressure
absolute pressure
material medium contact stainless steel 1.4301
connection G1/2A
connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
plug DIN 43650-A
with goose-neck
ACCESSORY
COMBINATIONS
looking plug
omni-P
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)...20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
PU-
K
KB04
PU-
02
02
05
10
S G
G
W
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
basic type
specification
ready-made cable
self makable cable 4-pole
material PUR
length 2 m
length 5 m
length 10 m
moulded-on plug
straight plug
angled plug 90
Flex-P
switch- or frequency output
0..10V or 4..20mA
PNP, NPN
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
289
Basic
ceramics cell
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Pressure Transmitter
EPS1
41.1.
EPS1.
TECHNICAL DATA
measurement
ranges
relative pressure
burst pressure
(bar)
accuracy
reproducebility
operating temp.
for electronics
operating
temperature
weight
MOUNTING
The sensors are screwed into a sleeve or a T-piece in the
pipework using a suitable sealing material (Teflon tape,
Sikurite seal, etc.). The mounting of the sensor should not
cause any significant change of cross-section in the pipe
system. When tightening the sensor, be sure to only use
the proper hexagonal wrench (27mm AF). Avoid points of
installation subject to high pressure shocks (see overload
limit).
After sealing you can turn the sensor into the correct
position for the cable connection. A mechanical block
limits the total range turnable of 360.
MATERIALS
pressure transducer
other materials
290
Basic
Pressure Transmitter
EPS1
ceramics cell
41.1.
EPS1.
ELECTRICAL DATA
supply voltage
analogue output
max. load
10..30 V DC 10%
4..20 mA
700 at 24 V (100 at
10V - 1k at 30V, linear to
the operation voltage )
for locking plug
M12x1, 4pole
or plug DIN 43650-A
IP 67 looking plug
IP 65 plug DIN 43650-A
connection
protection class
MOUNTING POSITION
sensor
1
2
brow n
+ (10-30VDC)
w hite
output
Before carrying out the electrical installation, make sure that the
supply voltage corresponds to the data specification.
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
air/gasses
oil
aggressive liquids
NOMENCLATURE
001
002
005
010
020
050
100
200
015
S
B
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
T
range
basic type
specification
0 - 1 bar
0 - 2 bar
0 - 5 bar
0 - 10 bar
0 - 20 bar
0 - 50 bar
0 - 100 bar
0 - 200 bar
relative pressure
material medium contact stainless steel 1.4571
connection G1/2A
connection at locking plugs M12x1, 4-pole
plug DIN 43650-A
with goose-neck
ACCESSORY
COMBINATIONS
looking plug
omni-P1
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)...20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
PU-
K
KB04
PU-
02
02
05
10
S G
G
W
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
basic type
specification
ready-made cable
self makable cable 4-pole
material PUR
length 2 m
length 5 m
length 10 m
moulded-on plug
straight plug
angled plug 90
Flex-P1
switch- or frequency output
0..10V or 4..20mA
PNP, NPN
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
291
Basic
Ceramics cell
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
45.1.
EDP1
EDP1.
TECHNICAL DATA
measurement
ranges
relative pressure
burst pressure
(bar)
differential
pressure range
accuracy
temp.-coefficient
operating
temperature
weight
burst
range
4
0- 1
6
0- 2
15
0- 5
40
0 - 10
60
0 - 20
150
0 - 50
280
0 - 100
to be specified by customer
minimum: 10% of operating range
maximum: operating range
1% of full scale
<0.05% / K
-40..85C
0.5 kg
MOUNTING
Join your pipework to P1 and P2 (see also Accessories).
When sealing, ensure cleanliness during assembly
P1
P2
MATERIALS
connection
ceramics cell
seal
other materials
292
Basic
Ceramics cell
45.1.
EDP1
EDP1.
ELECTRICAL DATA
4..20 mA (two-wire)
10..30 V DC
for locking plug
M12x1, 4pole
yes
yes
IP 67
output signal
supply voltage
connection
short-circuit proof
polarised
protection class
Sensor
brow n
+ (10..30V DC)
w hite
s ignal output
Sensor
MOUNTING POSITION
brow n
+ (10..30V DC)
signal output 2-10V
w hite
500
Ohm
0 V DC
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
air/gasses
oil
aggressive liquids
NOMENCLATURE
001
002
005
010
020
050
100
K 004 S
0050
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
0001
...
1000
004
range of the
individual cell.
EDP1- 001 R
basic type
specification
0 - 1 bar
0 - 2 bar
0 - 5 bar
0 - 10 bar
0 - 20 bar
0 - 50 bar
0 - 100 bar
Relativdruck
\
\
\
ACCESSORY
COMBINATIONS
omni-DP1
local electronic unit,
2xNPN and PNP switch
4(0)...20mA output
graphical LCD display
with flashing LED
program ring
PU-
K
K
KB04
PU-
02
02
05
10
S G
G
W
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
\
basic type
specification
ready-made cable
self makable cable 4-pole
material PUR
length 2 m
length 5 m
length 10 m
moulded-on plug
straight plug
angled plug 90
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
293
Basic
Honsberg at work
Monitoring exhaust
gases in vacuum pumps
Special versions of the Honsberg pressure switches of the PM series
are used for monitoring exhaust gases in vacuum pumps.
Pressure switch PM
The devices are calibrated to a fixed switching point of 1.5 barabs, with
a permissible tolerance of 0.22 bar and are used on the basis of the
following features:
l
l
l
l
l
On account of the media quality involved, the devices have Teflon diaphragms. Contacts with gold coating are used for very small switching
capacities. This demanding application is mastered reliably by Honsberg
pressure switches.
294
Why to use a
Basic
pressure instrument
295
Where to use a
Basic
pressure instrument
Market segments
l Vacuum pumps
l Printing machines
l Pressure generators
l Compressors, Filters
Application
l Monitoring of exhaust gas
l Pressure monitoring in paper powder coating
l Triggering second energy supply in dual cell compressors
l Monitoring differential pressure with filters
296
Integrated Systems
flow
level
temperature
pressure
Application
l Universal use as threshold alarm or/and transmitter.
Advantages
l The system comprises identical components for the various
parameters in compact dimensions.
Omni
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Flex
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Contents
Omni
General description
298
System of instruments
299
300
Technical data
300
Terminal assignment
301
Mounting
301
Device description
301
Flex
General descrition
305
System of instruments
306
Technical data
306
Terminal assignment
307
Mounting
307
Device description
307
l Switching
l Indicating
l Metering
297
Basic
298
Systems of Instruments
Omni-converter
Switching points can be set directly on site with these sensors for
upward and downward excursions of process values. Using the display
this setting can also be carried out without the process. The momentary values at the measuring point are always visible and all the important
parameters can be called up at the point of measurement (this saves
time during installation and set-up and when trouble-shooting in your
process). The analogue current signal can be evaluated over long
distances and the momentary value made available remotely. The sensor is configured to your specification. It is therefore immediately ready
for use without you having to do any programming. If you need to
change parameters, then you can do this directly on the sensor with
the programming ring without any additional device or tool.
The complete omni sensor range is formed in an extremely modular way
using a kit system (hardware and software). A 16-bit microcontroller
with a 14-bit A/D converter and a 12-bit D/A converter provides the
necessary processing speed and measurement accuracy. The signal is
displayed with units using a back-lit LCD graphical display and converted
to a 4(0)..20mA signal. Two switching points with alternatively a PNP or
NPN output can be programmed over the complete range.
combination
flow
dynamic
flap
The switching point hystereses can be set separately in value and direction (min./max. switching value). Upward and downward crossings of
switching points and error messages are shown in the display with a
flashing red LED, easily visible at a distance, as well as a message
Other parameters can be changed using a code:
Signal filter, selectable unit (bar, psi ...) incl. automatic conversion of the
values, selectable 0 or 4..20mA output, value assignment of 4(0) and
20 mA (setting of zero point and span).
The complete housing can be rotated about the mechanical connection
so that the correct reading position can be set after sealing.
rotor
turbine
gear wheel
piston
inline design
calorimetric
Vortex
level
float
ultrasonic
temperature PT100
pressure
strain-gauge
differential- measuring
pressure
bridge
299
Basic
The programming ring can be pulled off, turned through 180 and
replaced. Then programming is no longer possible on turning the ring
further.
Technical Data
supply voltage
power consumption
measurement ranges
accuracy
reproducibility
operating temperature
storage temperature
signal output
switching points
S1 and S2
hysteresis
display
connection
protection
material
Terminal assignment
Dimension
primary-sensor omni-electronic
The switchpoints are changing to PNP or NPN depending to your interface automaticly. Please you use shielded cable, signal lines < 30m and
power supply lines < 10m.
Mounting
Please refer to the separate sensor description
Device description
Please send for our Omni cataloque for detailed device description
Flow meters
omni MR1K/HD1K/
HD1KV/HR1M
A mechanical spring-supported piston
is deflected by the flow. The flowproportional position of the piston is
transmitted to an analogue hall sensor
via a magnet.
l
l
l
l
Piston
Female thread DN 8-50
Hall-Sensor
Ranges from
0.4-150 l/min
l Pressure stage PN 200
l Max. temperature 150 C
l Brass material
omni-XF
The flowing liquids move a thin springy
flap that covers the entire flow area. A
magnet on the flap creates a changing
magnetic field, which is detected by a
Hall sensor, when the flap is moved.
Due to the spring-like quality of the flap
and the molded stop, even strong
impacts caused by the water are
absorbed well.
l
l
l
l
l
Dynamic flap
DN 8-20 internal thread
Range: 1 - 80 l/min
Max. temperature: 60 C
Material: brass/copper
301
Basic
omni-RR
This flow meter comprises a rotor
which is set into motion by the flow
speed. The number of resolutions is
proportional to the flow rate per time
unit. Rotation speed is recorded by different sensor systems depending on
the different housing materials involved.
l
l
l
l
l
l
Rotor
DN 10-200
Ranges from 0.5-60 l/min
Temperature max. 100 C
Plastic PN 16
Brass / stainless steel
PN 100
l
l
l
l
l
l
Turbine
Female thread DN 25
Ranges from 1-80 l/min
Temperature max. 60 C
POM PN 10
Brass PN 10O
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Turbine
Female thread DN 25
Ranges from 1-80 l/min
Temperature max. 60 C
POM PN 10
Brass PN 10O
Optional: filter, flow limiter,
check valve
l
l
l
l
l
l
Turbine
Female thread DN 15-50
Ranges from 0.11-68 m3/h
Pressure stage PN 250
Temperature max. 150 C
Stainless steel material
l
l
l
l
l
l
Toothed gear
Female thread DN 8-25
Ranges from 1-150 l/min
Temperature max. 85 C
PN 100
Aluminium or stainless steel
material
l
l
l
l
l
Calorimetric
Meter diameter: 6 - 10
Range: 0.01 - 10 l/min
Max. temperature: 7 C
Material: stainless steel
omni-RRT
A turbine serves as the primary measured value recorder, with its number
of rotations in linear proportion to the
flow rate
omni-RRT1
A turbine serves as the primary measured value recorder, with its number
of rotations in linear proportion to the
flow rate. Can be combined with adapters including check valve, flow limiter
or filter.
omni-RT
A turbine serves as the primary measured value recorder, with its number
of rotations in linear proportion to the
flow rate
omni-VHZ
The flow meter measures the flow
according to the volumetric principle
and is suitable for viscous, liquid, selflubricating media. Also suitable for
liquids containing water such as soaps,
pastes, emulsions with non-abrasive
properties.
omni-FIN
The calorimetric sensor measures low
flow rates. The calorimetric concept
of the flow sensors is based on the use
of 2 temperature sensors. One of the
sensors constantly maintains a level
temperature, thereby creating a level
difference in temperature between the
two sensors when the liquid to be
measured stands still.
302
omni-CF
A small triangular piece that covers the
entire cross-section of the flowmeter
creates a vortex in the flow (Karmann
vortex, vortex effect). The vortex
frequency is proportional to the flow
rate and is detected by a Piezo sensor
that is located behind the triangular
piece. The entire unit, vortex piece and
sensor, is designed as module and is
inserted into the pipe. Thus, the flowmeter and the entire measuring unit
can be separated quickly.
l
l
l
l
l
Vortex
DN 8-25 internal thread
Range: 0.6 - 240 l/min
Max. temperature: 80 C
Material: brass
omni-F
The calorimetric principle of flow monitoring is based on two temperature
sensors. One of these sensors is heated constantly so that there is a constant difference in temperature between the two temperature sensors
when the metering material is at a
standstill.
l Calorimetric
l Nominal diameter
from DN 10
l Ranges 1-150 cm/s
l Pressure range PN 200
l Temperature max. 70 C
l Stainless steel material
Level meters
omni-LC
A float fitted with a magnet switches a
reed chain within the slide pipe which
is equipped with resistors like a potentiometer. Safe level detection is achieved thanks to the switching states
overlapping. The resolution is up to
10-20 mm and has good repeatability
qualities.
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Ultrasonic
Range from 100-2500 mm
Temperature max. 70C
Material PET / POM
omni-L
The sensor consists of the primary
sensor, an ultrasonic sensor, which
determines in a non-contact manner
distances to materials of various types
(liquids, bulk goods, solids) and the evaluation electronics. The ultrasonic sensor operates according to the principle
of the measurement of propagation
time. Transmitted ultrasonic pulses are
reflected at the surface and arrive
back at the converter after an echo
period
303
Basic
Temperature meters
omni-T
The primary sensor is a PT100 resistance sensor in thin-film technology
which offers a very good response time
thanks to the 4 mm lance thickness.
l
l
l
l
PT100
Ranges from 0-100 C
Temperature max. 100 C
Stainless steel material
Pressure meters
omni-P/P1
The pressure meters comprise a
primary sensor and the integrated
evaluation electronics.
The primary sensor is available in two
different technologies.
l Front-flush diaphragm/
ceramic cell
l Range up to 400 bar
l Temperature max. 120 C
l Stainless steel material
omni-DP1
The differential pressure measurement
cell is manufactured with two separate
ceramic sensors in thick-film technology. The bridge signals are temperature
compensated on the relevant cell.
The medium is exposed to high quality
materials only such as Al2O3 ceramic,
stainless steel and Viton 0-rings and is
therefore ideally suitable for
liquid/liquid applications.
304
l
l
l
l
Ceramic Cell
Range from 20O bar
Temperature max. 70 C
Stainless steel material
flow
temperature
pressure
level
analogue output:
l 4..20 mA or 0..10 V
switch:
l PNP, NPN or NPN oc (open collector) switch
l min-, max-switch or frequency-output
flashing LED:
l yellow LED for switching output
(ON = OK /OFF = alarm)
Programming
A calibration magnet pinched to the instrument may be used to select
the switch point or full scale of the analogue output. The calibration
spot is clearly identified on the label.
Hold magnet
305
Basic
System of Instuments
Dimension
The Flex-electronic linearised and conditions the primary signal to a standard 4..20 mA or 0..10 V output and offers a flexible switch alarm.
The sensor operate by a 16-bit processor, a 12-bid a/d and 12-bid d/a
converter. Linearization and calibration is provided automatically. A flash
memory guarantees interchange ability of all program parameters.
The signal options are pnp/npn transistor output or a frequency signal.
The analogue output 4..20 mA or 0..10 V are available.
Flex-converter
All signal configurations are subjected to highly modular selection schema by magnetic calibration.
Options available:
l variable span of analogue outputs
combination
l variable hysteresis
l min or max switch
l inversion of output signal
flow
piston
inline design
l window function
l delay subsequent to voltage input
l switch delay (on/off)
dynamic
flap
turbine
gear wheel
calorimetric
Vortex
level
float
temperature
PT100
Technical Data
supply voltage
power consumption
measurement ranges
accuracy
reproducibility
operating temperature
storage temperature
signal output
switching output
hysteresis
display
pressure
306
strain-gaute
measuring
bridge
connection
protection class
material
Pin configuration
Installation
Please see the individual sensor descriptions.
Device description
Please send for our Flex catalogue for detailed device descriptions.
Flow meters
Flex-MR1K/HD1K/HD2K/HR1M
A mechanical spring-supported piston
is deflected by the flow. The flowproportional position of the piston is
transmitted to an analogue Hall sensor
via a magnet.
l
l
l
l
Piston
Female thread DN 8-50
Hall-Sensor
Ranges from
0.4 - 150 l/min
l Pressure stage PN 200
l Max. temperature 150 C
l Brass material
Flex-XF
The flowing liquids move a thin springy
flap that covers the entire flow area. A
magnet on the flap creates a changing
magnetic field, which is detected by a
Hall sensor, when the flap is moved.
Due to the spring-like quality of the flap
and the molded stop, even strong
impacts caused by the water are
absorbed well.
l
l
l
l
l
Dynamic flap
DN 8-20 internal thread
Range: 1 - 80 l/min.
Max. temperature: 60 C
Material: brass/plastic
307
Basic
Flex-RR
This flow meter comprises a rotor
which is set into motion by the flow
speed. The number of resolutions is
proportional to the flow rate per time
unit. Rotation speed is recorded by different sensor systems depending on
the different housing materials involved.
l
l
l
l
l
l
Rotor
DN 10-200
Ranges from 0.5-60 l/min
Temperature max. 100 C
Plastic PN 16
Brass/stainless steel
PN 100
l
l
l
l
l
l
Turbine
Female thread DN 25
Ranges from 1-80 l/min
Temperature max. 60 C
POM PN 10
Brass PN 100
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Turbine
Female thread DN 25
Ranges from 1-80 l/min
Temperature max. 60 C
POM PN 10
Brass PN 100
Optional: filter, flow limiter,
check valve
l
l
l
l
l
l
Turbine
Female thread DN 15-50
Ranges from 0.11-68 m/h
Pressure stage PN 250
Temperature max. 150 C
Stainless steel material
Flex-RRT
A turbine serves as the primary measured value recorder, with its number
of rotations in linear proportion to the
flow rate.
Flex-RRT1
A turbine serves as the primary measured value recorder, with its number
of rotations in linear proportion to the
flow rate. Can be combined with adapters including check valve, flow limiter
Flex-RT
A turbine serves as the primary measured value recorder, with its number
of rotations in linear proportion to the
flow rate.
308
Flex-VHZ
The flow meter measures the flow
according to the volumetric principle
and is suitable for viscous, liquid, selflubricating media. Also suitable for
liquids containing water such as soaps,
pastes, emulsions with non-abrasive
properties.
l
l
l
l
l
l
Toothed gear
Female thread DN 8-25
Ranges from 1-150 l/min
Temperature max. 85 C
PN 100
Aluminium or stainless steel
material
Flex-F
The calorimetric principle of flow monitoring is based on two temperature
sensors. One of these sensors is heated constantly so that there is a constant difference in temperature between the two temperature sensors
when the metering material is at a
standstill.
l Calorimetric
l Nominal diameter
from DN 10
l Ranges 1-150 cm/s
l Pressure range PN 200
l Temperature max. 70 C
l Stainless steel material
Flex-FIN
The calorimetric sensor measures low
flow rates. The calorimetric concept
of the flow sensors is based on the use
of 2 temperature sensors. One of the
sensors constantly maintains a level
temperature, thereby creating a level
difference in temperature between
the two sensors when the liquid to be
measured stands still.
l
l
l
l
l
l
Calorimetric
Pipe diameter: 6 - 10
Range: 0.01 - 10 l/min
PN 200 pressure level
Max. temperature: 70 C
Material: stainless steel
l
l
l
l
l
Vortex
DN 8-25 internal thread
Range: 0.6 - 240 l/min
Max. temperature: 80 C
Material: brass
Flex-CF
A small triangular piece that covers the
entire cross-section of the flowmeter
creates a vortex in the flow (Karmann
vortex, vortex effect). The vortex
frequency is proportional to the flow
rate and is detected by a Piezo sensor
that is located behind the triangular
piece. The entire unit, vortex piece and
sensor, is designed as module and is
inserted into the pipe. Thus, the flowmeter and the entire measuring unit
can be separated quickly.
309
Basic
Level meters
Flex-LC
A float fitted with a magnet switches a
reed chain within the slide pipe which
is equipped with resistors like a potentiometer. Safe level detection is achieved thanks to the switching states
overlapping. The resolution is up to
10-20 mm and has good repeatability
qualities.
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
PT100
Ranges from 0-100 C
Temperature max. 100 C
Stainless steel material
Temperature meters
Flex-T
The primary sensor is a PT100 resistance sensor in thin-film technology
which offers a very good response time
thanks to the 4 mm lance thickness.
Pressure meters
Flex--P/P1
The pressure meters comprise a
primary sensor and the integrated
evaluation electronics.
The primary sensor is available in two
different technologies.
310
l Front-flush diaphragm/
ceramic cell
l Range up to 400 bar
l Temperature max. 120 C
l Stainless steel material
Transducers
The technology
Honsberg supplies a range of signal
transducers which can be used in combination with Honsberg devices or even
as stand-alone units within the context
of the metering task set.
Application
Evaluation or conversion of sensor signals
l
l
l
l
l
l
Signal transducers
Amplifiers
EX-amplifiers
Relays
Counters
Display units
Contents
Summary
312
Device descriptions
313
Advantages
l These components have been designed to match Honsberg
devices, and support operation and safety.
Input
Input
Frequency
Ex-separation
[switch, threshold]
4[0]..20 mA, 0..10 V
display, trend,
frequency minimising
linearizing
Analogue
Frequency
switch, threshold
normalisation, linearizing
display, trend
4[0]..20 mA, 0..10 V
M
l Signal processing
311
Basic
The combination
312
l standard
description
frequency switch
frequency sensor with current output
frequency/frequency converter
frequency sensor with voltage output
314
315
316
317
EEV1
EEV2
318
318
WE
319
MSR010
Multifunction relay
319
EEZ-904
Counter
319
ESA1
319
ESK2
320
ESK3
320
GIA
320
ELC
320
m standard option
page
type
EFFS
EFFI
EFFF
EFFU
special option
313
Basic
converter
Frequency Switch
EFFS
85.1.
EFFS.
TERMINAL ASSIGNMENT
Before carrying out the electrical installation, make sure that the
supply voltage corresponds to the data specification.
PNP
1
4
3
2
ADVANTAGE
The converter can be screwed into all HONSBERG rotor and turbine
flow meters which have an M12x1 screwed hole for the sensor.
Using the integral sensor, it receives a frequency signal proportional
to the flow and evaluates this signal. If the signal drops below the set
limit, an alarm signal is produced and the yellow LED in the plug
connector goes out.
brow n
black
Output
blue
0V
w hite
Programming
Output
0V
Programming
DIMENSIONS
PROGRAMMING
- Adjust set frequency (= set flow) in the system.
- Apply a pulse of at least 0.5 seconds duration on Pin 2 or white
wire (for lead version), (e.g. by bridging to the supply voltage or
pulse from PLC).
Immediately after programming, the sensor switches to the alarm
state. The alarm is cancelled once the flow increases such that the
threshold plus 12 Hz (= hysteresis) is reached.
After programming, Pin 2 (or the white wire) must either remain
unconnected or be connected to 0V.
NOMENCLATURE
EFFS- H P
TECHNICAL DATA
supply voltage
idle current
output
short circuit current
frequency range
connection
materials housing
protection class
operating temperature
weight
10..30 V DC
< 20 mA (without load)
NPN or PNP
max. 200 mA
4..10000 Hz
for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
Reservation according to DESINA
nickel plated brass, PA66
IP67
0..70 C
approximately 25 g
H
V
I
N
P
M
L
H
Y
Q
Q
Y
Y
Q
Y
Q
Y
basic type
specification
Hall
biased Hall
inductive
NPN
PNP
NPN open collector
min. switch
max. switch
locking plug M12x1, 4pole
MOUNTING
Screw the sensor into thread of the housing and turn it back a
quarter of complete turn.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
314
Basic
converter
85.1.
EFFI.
TERMINAL ASSIGNMENT
Before carrying out the electrical installation, make sure that the
supply voltage corresponds to the data specification.
1
brow n
4
3
2
black
current output
blue
0V
w hite
programming
DIMENSIONS
ADVANTAGE
The converter can be screwed into all HONSBERG rotor and turbine
flow meters which have an M12x1 screwed hole for the sensor.
Using the integral sensor, it receives a frequency signal proportional
to the flow and converts it to a proportional output current of 0(4)..20
mA.
PROGRAMMING
- Adjust max frequency (= max flow) in the system.
- Apply a pulse of at least 0.5 seconds duration on Pin 2 or white
wire (for lead version), (e.g. by bridging to the supply voltage or
pulse from PLC).
NOMENCLATURE
EFFI-
TECHNICAL DATA
supply voltage
idle current
current output
frequency range
connection
materials housing
protection class
operating temperature
weight
H
H
V
I
0
4
Y
Q
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
basic type
specification
Hall
biased Hall
inductive
current output
0 .. 20 mA
4 .. 20 mA
locking plug M12x1, 4pole
10..30 V DC
< 20 mA (without load)
0..20 mA or 4..20 mA
1..4095 Hz
for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
nickel plated brass, PA66
IP67
0..70 C
approximately 25 g
MOUNTING
Screw the sensor into thread of the housing and turn it back a
quarter of complete turn.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
315
Basic
Frequency/FrequencyConverter EFFF
converter
85.1.
EFFF.
TERMINAL ASSIGNMENT
Before carrying out the electrical installation, make sure that the
supply voltage corresponds to the data specification.
PNP
1
4
3
2
brow n
black
blue
ADVANTAGE
The converter can be screwed into all HONSBERG rotor and turbine
flow meters which have an M12x1 screwed hole for the sensor.
Using the integral sensor, it receives a frequency signal proportional
to the flow and calculates the output frequency. A yellow LED
indicates the status of the output, i.e. it flashes in the rythm of the
output frequency.
0V
w hite
Output
Programming
Output
0V
Programming
DIMENSIONS
After programming, Pin 2 (or the white wire) must either remain
unconnected or be connected to 0V.
MOUNTING
Screw the sensor into thread of the housing and turn it back a
quarter of complete turn.
TECHNICAL DATA
supply voltage
idle current
output
short circuit current
input Frequency range
output Frequency range
connection
materials housing
protection class
operating temperature
weight
10..30 V DC
< 20 mA (without load)
NPN or PNP
max. 200 mA
4..10000 Hz
10..2000 Hz
for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
Reservation according to DESINA
nickel plated brass, PA66
IP67
0..70 C
approximately 25 g
NOMENCLATURE
EFFF- H 10000 P
H
V
I
10000
P
F
A
2000
2000
N
P
M
Y
Q
Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Q
Y
basic type
specification
Hall
biased Hall
inductive
Input frequency (max. 10000, specificy only for fixed freq., otherwise 00000)
paired with HONSBERG unit
fixed input frequency
input frequency adjustable via program pin
max. output frequency (max. 2000, specification required)
NPN
PNP
NPN open collector
locking plug M12x1, 4pole
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
316
Basic
converter
85.1.
EFFU.
TERMINAL ASSIGNMENT
Before carrying out the electrical installation, make sure that the
supply voltage corresponds to the data specification.
1
4
3
2
Sensor with adjustable voltage output
Can be configured by user via pluggable pin (Teach-In)
M12x1 industry locking plug system
brown
black
voltage output
blue
white
0V
programming
DIMENSIONS
ADVANTAGE
The converter can be screwed into all HONSBERG rotor and turbine
flow meters which have an M12x1 screwed hole for the sensor.
Using the integral sensor, it receives a frequency signal and converts
it to a flow-proportional output voltage of 0(2)..10 V (linearization of
the flow meters curve is possible!).
PROGRAMMING
- Adjust max frequency (= max flow) in the system.
- Apply a pulse of at least 0.5 seconds duration on pin 2 or white
wire (for lead version), (e.g. by bridging to the supply voltage or
pulse from PLC).
NOMENCLATURE
EFFU- H U
H
V
I
0
2
5
Y
Q
Q
Y
Y
Y
0
Y
basic type
specification
Hall
biased Hall
inductive
voltage output
0 .. 10 V
2 .. 10 V
0 .. 5 V
locking plug M12x1, 4pole
TECHNICAL DATA
supply voltage
idle current
voltage output
frequency range
connection
materials housing
protection class
operating temperature
weight
10..30 V DC
< 20 mA (without load)
0..10 V or 2..10 V
(other values on request)
1..4095 Hz
for locking plug M12x1, 4-pole
nickel plated brass, PA66
IP67
0..70 C
approximately 25 g
MOUNTING
Screw the sensor into thread of the housing and turn it back a
quarter of complete turn.
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
317
Basic
converter
Ex-Amplifier
EEV1 / EEV2
80.1.
EEV.
WIRING DIAGRAM
R internal
4
11
6
R1
R2
I<0,1mA
I>Imax
DK
R internal
1
12
3
I<0,1mA
I>Imax
DK
P
7
10
2
R1 >1,8k / R2 <100k
EEV1: Imax = 30 mA
ADVANTAGE
The two-channel separation circuit amplifiers with transistor output
serve as an interface between electrical signals from the highly
combustible range (ex area) and the not highly combustible range
(non-ex area). The input signals (frequencies or switching signals) of
NAMUR- and other 2-wire-sensors, as well as mechanical contacts
or opto couplers are transferred to the outputs. The outputs are
among themselves and from the remaining circuit galvanically
separated. The electrical circuits of the sensor are galvanically
connected with the power supply. The intrinsically safe electric
circuits are suitable for zone 1, 2, 21 and 22.
24V20%
AC/DC
PA
Rintern = 510
EEV2: Imax = 6 mA
ASSEMBLY
The device is to be assembled onto a hat rail in a switch cabinet or a
similar installation (min. IP20) outside the Ex-zone area.
DIMENSIONS
22
107,5
operating voltage
power consumption DC
no-load voltage
short-circuit current
output power
EEx ia IIC
outer inductance
max.
EEx ib IIC
EEx ia IIC
outer capacitance
max.
EEx ib IIC
actuating signal
outputs
galvanic separation
electrical connection
connection diameter
material housing
protection IEC 529
connectors
operating temperature
conformity
EEV1
EEV2
24 V AC/DC 20%
3,6 W
max. 10 V DC
max. 75 mA
max. 9,3 mA
188 mW
24 mW
3 mH
3 mH
6,7 mH
330 mH
475 nF
641 nF
4 F
4 F
< 7 mA
< 1,4 mA
> 14 mA
> 2,8 mA
2x open collector
Umax = 30 V AC/DC
up to a crest value of the
nominal voltage of 60 V
screw terminals
< 1,5mm with end-sleeves
PA66
IP 30
IP 20
-25..+60C
PTB Nr. Ex-99.E.2073 X
CE
92
TECHNICAL DATA
Turbines
Volumetric flow meters
product information
4.2.RRI.
4.2.RRH.
4.2.RR.32
5.1.RT.
6.1.VHZ.
EEV1 is applicable to 2-wire-sensors according to DIN EN 60947-56, 2-wire-Hall-sensors and floating mechanical contacts or optocouplers.
EEV2 is applicable to NAMUR-sensors only.
318
Device description
WE - Isolating switching amplifier with relay output
The residual current flow of 100 mA
is monitored by an auxiliary circuit. In
the event of a reduction in this current
e.g. by a breakage in the control lead,
the output relay is released.
l One- or two-channel
l Control current circuit
l Increases switching
capacity
l Off-delay
EEZ-904 - Counter
These devices can be programmed by
the user to count time or pulses, as a
position display or frequency counter
and have two pre-selectable outputs.
All the settings, including programming
the pre-selected values, are carried
out using just four keys on the front of
the device and a plain text menu in the
display.
switching module
l Switching point can be
faded in
l Switching point can be set
319
Basic
l Monitoring electronics
puts
l Setting of switching values
using magnet
l Switch state indication
using LEDs
l Monitoring electronics
loads
l Red / green status
display
l Extremely easy to use
320
Filters, accessories
The technology
Filters
Dirt traps with magnetic separators for dirt
protection and separation of ferrite sludge.
Extremely fine filtration of liquids.
Accessories
The accessories range includes mechanical
components such as valves [VC], valve
strips [VB], fittings [TS] and flanges [FL] or
electrical components as contact protection [HE].
Contents
Application
l
l
l
l
Soiling protection
Regulating
Contact to pipeline
Contact protection
System description
322
Device descriptions
323
l Filtering
l Regulating
321
Basic
Filters
Honsberg filters are provided to protect Honsberg devices against
soiling or as independent components for coarse and fine filtration
of liquids.
The fine filters [ZE] have filter cartridges in a fineness range from
5-250 m in metal or ceramic and are thus able to take over tasks
which require extremely fine filtration.
A standard dirt trap is only able to achieve part of its protective function
where ferrite abrasion is present in the medium, which is much smaller
in grain size than the mesh of the dirt trap and is thus rinsed through
it. For such cases, Honsberg magnetic filters [ZV] provide additional
protection in that a magnetic rod which is equipped with shielded pairs
of magnets is positioned in the centre of the dirt trap sieve and precipitates ferrite materials.
The individual pairs of magnets are poled in a certain way and shielded
from one another by soft iron discs creating an optimum magnetic field
in the area of the sieve, thus guaranteeing better efficiency.
The connection of the magnetic rod with the dirt trap cover leads to
simple cleaning of the magnetic rod within the context of the specified
maintenance intervals. The application ranges of Honsberg magnetic
filters include industrial lubricating and cooling circuits as well as wherever the protection of high-quality metering devices such as heat counters etc. must be guaranteed, such as in the area of heating technology
with boilers and radiators.
Accessories
The accessories range includes mechanical components such as valves
[VC], valve strips [VB], fittings [TS] and flanges [FL] or electrical components as contact protection [HE].
322
max. temperature C
water
oil
gas/air
16
150
324
ZEK
ZEL
ZEG
fine filter
fine filter
fine filter
4 - 15
4 - 15
10 - 20
16
16
16
150
150
150
l
l
l
l
l
l
3
3
3
325
VB
manifold
25
100
TS
control valves
10 - 50
T-fitting
25
VC
control valves
13
FL
flange connection
welding socket
16
HE
spark protector
m standard option
20
40-500
120
327
328
329
330
85
special option
Basic
page
connections
15 - 80
miscellaneous
discreption
magnetic filter
nominal diameter
type
filter
supporting components
l standard
ZV
323
Spark protector
HE100ZB
84.1
HE.
Technical data:
Capacity
Capacity tolerance
Resistance range
Resistance tolerance
Voltage
Peak voltage
Power
Operating temperature
Approval
Weight
0.047 - 0.47 F
20%
22 - 470 W
30%
250 V AC 50 Hz; 630 V DC
1000 V
0,5 W
max. 85C
S, N, D, Fl, VDE, SEV, UL
0.01 kg
Dimensions
Y compact
Y economical
Principle
The reed switches or micro-switches used in Honsberg monitoring devices have a limited electrical switching capacity
which can be taken from the descriptions for the individual
devices. With higher switching values or if inductive loads or
long line lengths are involved, a suppression circuit is recommended for the reed switch or micro-switch. The type
HE100ZE is available for this purpose.
323
Basic
Magnetic Filter
Volumat ZV-...GR
filter
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
60.1.
ZV.GR
ZV-025GR
bronze
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
PN
bar
Qmax. rec.
m/h H2O
number of
magnets
H
mm
L
mm
H1
mm
AF
mm
AF1
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
Rp 1/2"
Rp 3/4"
G1
G 1 1/4
G 1 1/2
G2
G 2 1/2
G3
ZV-015GR
ZV-020GR
ZV-025GR
ZV-032GR
ZV-040GR
ZV-050GR
ZV-065GR
ZV-080GR
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
16
2.3
2.7
4.4
5.1
7
11.9
18.4
30
2
3
3
3
3
4
5
4
42
50
62
78
82
95
125
140
66
77
90
112
120
150
220
250
84
100
124
156
164
190
250
280
25
31
38
47
54
66
85
100
22
27
32
41
46
56
70
75
11
14
14
16
16
20
22
25
0.30
0.40
0.65
1.05
1.40
2.20
3.80
5.80
media temperature
average pressure loss
mesh size
max. 150C
0.15bar at Qmax.
600m
MATERIALS
filter
seal
MOUNTING POSITION
NOMENCLATURE
ZV-
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
015
015
020
025
032
040
050
065
080
Special option
VARIO
G R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
0
nominal diameter
housing
magnetic candle
basic type
specification
DN 15 - Rp1/2"
DN 20 - Rp3/4"
DN 25 - G1
DN 32 - G1 1/4
DN 40 - G1 1/2
DN 50 - G2
DN 65 - G2 1/2
DN 80 - G3
female thread
housing bronze
filter mesh aperture 250m
flange housing cast iron
oil
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
324
Basic
filter
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Fine Filter
Volumat ZE
61.1.
ZE.
TECHNICAL DATA
G
Type
ZEK-004GP....
ZEL-004GP....
ZEK-008GP....
ZEL-008GP....
ZEK-010GP....
ZEL-010GP....
ZEG-010GP....
ZEK-015GP....
ZEL-015GP....
ZEG-015GP....
ZEG-020GP....
G1/8
PP
G1/4
G3/8
G1/2
G3/4
operational pressure
operational temperature
H
mm
L
mm
D
mm
X
mm
weight
kg
47
84
50
83
52
86
114
53
87
114
116
57.5
57.5
74
74
74
74
90
74
74
90
90
48.5
48.5
48.5
48.5
48.5
48.5
75
48.5
48.5
75
75
19
19
19
19
19
19
20
19
19
20
20
0.050
0.075
0.050
0.070
0.065
0.085
0.175
0.060
0.080
0.170
0.190
10 bar at 24C
7 bar at 52C
max. 52C
MATERIALS
housing
cap
filter
seal
PP
PP or transparent nylon
UHMW-PE sintered plastic or stainless steel
NBR / Viton
HONSBERG & CO.KG Tenter Weg 2-8 42897 Remscheid Germany
Tel. +49(0)2191 9672-0 Fax +49(0)2191 9672-40 www.honsberg.com [email protected]
325
Basic
filter
Fine Filter
Volumat ZE
61.1.
ZE.
ELECTRICAL DATA
No electrical components.
MOUNTING POSITION
METERING SUBSTANCES
water
gas/air
NOMENCLATURE
004
008
010
015
020
G P
P
N
005
005
035
080
050
100
300
N
V
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
nominal
diameter
ZEKZELZEG-
015
filter
ZEK-
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
326
Basic
accessories
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
Manifold
Plus VB-...GA/K/M
70.1.
VB.
VB-020GA3
mit NJV-015WM
TECHNICAL DATA
Valve port
lenght
mm (without plug)
A
mm
weight
kg (aluminium)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
50
100
150
200
250
300
350
400
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
135
160
185
0.6
1.1
1.6
2.1
2.4
3.0
3.4
3.8
pressure
media temperature
PN 25 bar
max. 110C
MATERIALS
housing
seal
wetted parts
external parts
VB-...GA
aluminium anodized
NBR
brass, brass nickel plated
Al, brass nickel plated
NOMENCLATURE
VB-
020
015
020
G A
G
A
K
M
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
R
Z
Z
Z
0
0
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
basic type
specification
nominal diameter DN15 - G1/2
nominal diameter DN20 - G3/4
female thread
aluminium
stainless steel (wetted parts and housing 1.4305)
brass (housing Ms58 nickel plated)
1-fold port
2-fold port
3-fold port
4-fold port
5-fold port
6-fold port
7-fold port
8-fold port
All technical changes reserved
ZBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
327
Basic
accessories
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
connection T-fittings
Plus TS-
71.1.
TS.
TECHNICAL DATA
pressure PN25
MATERIALS
TS-.M
TS-.K
Type
H
mm
L
mm
X
mm
28
28
29
33
37
40
49
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
10
10
12
12
12
12
12
TS-..010
TS-..015
TS-..020
TS-..025
TS-..032
TS-..040
TS-..050
NOMENCLATURE
TS-
1 M
1
2
3
M
K
010
010
015
020
025
032
040
050
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
TS-
basic type
specification
T-T-fittings
for paddle switch (UM/UR)
for calorimetric system liquid media
for calorimetrig system gaseous media (additional plastic)
brass
stainless steel 1.4305
DN 10 - G3/8
DN 15 - G1/2
DN 20 - G3/4
DN 25 - G1
DN 32 - G1 1/4
DN 40 - G1 1/2
DN 50 - G2
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
328
Basic
Control Valves
Plus VC.-004GK
accessories
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
70.2.
VC.
VCS-004GK1R
VCP-004GK1S
TECHNICAL DATA
Valve
NPT
Type
taper size
maximum flow
cm/min
VCS-004GK1.
1
VCS-004GK2.
2
VCS-004GK3.
3
VCP-004GK1.
1
Precision
NPT 1/8"
VCP-004GK2.
2
VCP-004GK3.
3
VCP-004GK4.
4
VCP-004GK5.
5
VCP-004GK6.
6
* based on 1bar rel. inlet pressure of air, exhausting to atmosphere
Standard
NPT 1/8"
pressure
media temperature
PN 16 bar
max. 120C
water
760
2150
3550
17
28
74
219
722
1255
air *
13000
46000
68000
253
470
1100
3800
11900
21300
H1
mm
H2
mm
weight
kg
67
54
0.16
77
64
0.18
MATERIALS
housing
seal
orifice
NOMENCLATURE
VCSVCP-
004
004
G K
1
2
3
4
5
6
S
A
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Taper Size
VCS-
basic type
specification
standard valve 9 turns to full open
precision valve 16 turns to full open
DN 4 - NPT 1/8"
female thread
stainless steel
1
2
3
4
only VCP5
6
sraight trough (180)
right angle (90)
All technical changes reserved
ZBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
329
Basic
Flange Connection
Plus FL-032S/K
accessories
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS
71.1.
FL.
TECHNICAL DATA
Flange DIN 2527 PN 16 nominal diameter 32
Types of contact faces DIN 2526 Form C
Seal 82/43x2 Novapress 200
Hexagon head screws DIN EN 24017 M16x50-5.6
Hexagon nuts DIN EN 24032 M16-5
DN 40-65
DN 80-500
DN D
40
50
65
65
61
57
48.3
60.3
76.1
NOMENCLATURE
FL-
032
032
S
S
K
040
040
050
065
080
100
125
150
200
250
300
400
500
Z
Z
Z
R
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
Z
FL-
basic type
specification
mounting flange, welded to connection piece including screw, nut and seal.
DN 32
steel
stainless steel
DN 40
DN 50
DN 65
DN 80
DN 100
DN 125
DN 150
DN 200
DN 250
DN 300
DN 400
DN 500
All technical changes reserved
ZBASIC Standard
PLUS Accessories
not recommendable
330
Milling centre in
the mechanical production
The Honsberg product you are using thus has the best
possible pre-conditions for fulfilling its planned metering and
monitoring task reliably over a long service life.
European approval
for electronic safety
Metering machine
331
Basic
Quality
General principles
A high and constant standard of quality is an important pre-requisite
for a partner of industrial plant construction in sometimes safetyrelated applications. These requirements are implicated by Honsberg
as follows:
l
l
l
l
l
l
Individual testing
Every order we are entrusted with is tested and released individually
on the basis of the order data before dispatch.
Flow
0.01-5000 l/min
Level
20-2000 mm
System-related design
Temperature
-40 +250 C
Pressure
-1 +400 bar
332
Pressure loss
Hysteresis
Max. flow quantities
Tolerance
Repetition accuracy
dependent on Qmax
selection possible
2-3 m/s
1-5%
1%
Approvals
ATEX
GL
DIN-GOST
TV
KTA
Services include
l Support during initial operation
l Repair or replacement
l Application advice
Service telephone:
Tel.: +49 (0) 2191 / 9672-22
333
Basic
Safety first
Planning data for installation
Device description
l Monitor - switching device
l Pointer - local or remote display in an accuracy range from 5 %
l Meter - local metering unit or continuous and linear signal
generation in an accuracy range of up to 5 %
The device function
l Measured value - current display
l Final value - maximum display / switching value
Flow speed
l Tolerance
Tolerance is the extent of the deviation of a parameter from the
normal status or normal dimension. Tolerance specifications are
given within the context of the device description and can fluctuate under application conditions.
l Repeating accuracy - deviation during permanent function
20% safety
max. switch-on point
incl. tolerances
switching hysteresis
max. switch-off point
switch-off point
Example:
Switch-off end
4.2 l/min
Tolerance
0.3 l/min
Hysteresis
0.5 l/min
334
l Flow rate
Mechanical and electronic flow meters are designed for a certain flow rate or flow speed. We specify these data with a recommendation for a maximum flow speed in the area of 2-3
m/sec. or according to individual specifications for the respective product group. The maximum recommended flow rate can
be exceeded. In this case increased pressure loss or heavier
material wear must be expected.
tolerance
Qmin.
l Metering range
The metering range describes the operative spread within which
the device can be used. This can be the adjustment range for
the switching point or the display range of a metering unit. We
aim to make this spread as large as possible to extend the possibilities of each individual device. The working range is usually the
factor 1:10 e.g. 10-100 l/min.
= 5 l/min
+ 20 % safety
= 6l/min
l Hysteresis
The switching difference with switching devices and the display
difference with display devices represent important operating
data for the function of metering devices. The switching difference defines the difference between the switch-on and switch-off
points with increasing or decreasing flow rate. This difference
value is determined by the switching characteristic or the
mechanical function of the metering unit. In the case of switching devices it must be ensured that the switch-on point is
reached as a pre-condition for the contact function. In the case
of display instruments there is a difference in display with
increasing and decreasing flow rate.
l Direction of flow
The direction of flow must be observed, and is marked on every
device.
l Settling range
The minimum length of the settling ranges depends on the
respective application case. Basically, greater settling ranges
are required when elbows or fittings are built into the intake
side. Settling ranges of 5xDN are recommended.
l Pressure loss
The term pressure loss describes the drop in pressure caused by the device itself. This value depends largely on
the device design. It is important that the system pressure
is above the value of pressure loss in order to guarantee
component function. The pressure loss values have been calculated on the basis of a flow speed of 2 m/sec. When this
figure is exceeded, pressure loss increases disproportionately.
Electrical details
l
l
l
l
Pressure loss
Dp 1 bar
And finally
Initial operation
Certain basic principles must be taken into account during initial
mechanical operation and electrical wiring. These are applicable
for all HONSBERG products.
(1) Pressure data must be observed according to device
specification, as must the temperature range.
HONSBERG
(3) Straight stretches before and after the devices are beneficial to the device function in the sense of a laminar flow
profile.
(4) The circuit can either be seen on the device label or
described in the delivery papers. In unfavourable cases
[e.g. inductive or capacitive load], plan protective wiring
(5) Clean the pipework system before installation. If permanent
soiling occurs, use a magnetic filter [HONSBERG Volumat]
or a dirt trap.
Customer service and sales office
Tel. +49 (0) 2191/9672-0
335
Basic
Operation
H2O
oil viscosity
100mm/s
air / gas
200mm/s
40 - 99%
see page 15 + 49
1 bar air
piston
100%
float
100%
paddle
100%
rotor
100%
Oils to 10 mm/s
80%
on request
turbine
100%
Oils to 15 mm/s
80%
on request
gear wheel,
oval wheel
100%
100%
100%
not
recommendable
calorimetric
100%
on request
on request
on request
magnetic inductiv
100%
prohibitive
prohibitive
prohibitive
level
100%
special scaling
3500%
special scaling
70 - 80%
see page 115
special scaling
1500%
temperature
independent of media
pressure
independent of media
prohibitive
Viscosity
Function piston standard
Temperature
Material stability
brass
cast iron
cast steel
bronze
+
0
+
0
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ good
+
+
+
O
0
+
0
+
+
+
+
+
+
-
+
+
+
O
0
+
0
+
+
+
+
+
+
-
stainless steel
stainless steel
V2A
V4A
0
+
+
+
+
+
0
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
0
+
+
+
+
+
0
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
-
measuring material
acetic acid
acetone
alcohol
alkalis
butyric acid
carbonic acid
chlorine
common salt
distilled water
glyceric acid
hydrochloric acid
lime water
mineral oil
natural gas
paraffin
petrol
steam
sulphuric acid
O Sufficient - unsifficing
337
Basic
Materials
Material selection is divided into 3 classes:
1. wetted and pressurized
2. wetted non pressurized
3. neither wetted nor pressurized
The standard materials are
Class
1
l Brass
l Brass
l Brass
l Stainless steel
l Stainless steel
l Stainless steel
l Plastic
l Plastic
l Plastic
l Red bronze
l Bronze
l Steel
l Cast iron
l Copper
l Casting compound
l Cast steel
l Glass
l Magnetic materials
l Copper
l Glass
l Sealing materials
l Elastomers
Special options
The above device descriptions have conveyed a wide range of data and
technical possibilities. If you have decided in favour of a HONSBERG
product, our team is ready to process your order reliably.
Otherwise we recommend contacting HONSBERG for individual advice
and project assistance within the context of the VARIO programme
segment. Please let us have information about your case of application
and the task to be solved.
338
Mechanics
Electrics
Function
l Pressure stage up
to 500 bar
l Special thread
l Special flange
l Special materials
l Coating of the parts
in contact with
media
l Damping of moving
parts (with air and
gases)
l Version for
specified metering
materials
l Selected switching
function
l Multi-function
(integrated flow,
temperature, pressure monitoring
and metering)
Art of combination
The idea
Hermetical separation of primary measured value acquisition
and secondary measured value evaluation.
Primary measured
value acquisition
Piston
Float
Paddle
Rotor
Turbine
Gear wheel
Oval wheel
Flap
Sphere
Secondary measured
value evaluation
h
e
r
m
e
t
i
c
a
l
s
e
p
a
r
a
t
i
o
n
Reed switch
Micro-switch
Hall sensor
Inductive proximity
switch
Optical sensor
Metering unit
Temperature sensor
Bimetal
Pressure sensor
The advantages
l Optimal matching of mechanical and electrical components
l Non-contact triggering of contacts and sensors
l Hermetic separation of mechanical and electrical components
339
Basic
Honsberg
staff structure
1. productive
2. technical administration
3. commercial administration
Honsberg
periode of service
(years)
1.
2.
3.
4.
15 +
10 +
5+
< 5+
Honsberg
age structure
1.
2.
3.
4.
- 30
- 40
- 50
>50
Jahre
Jahre
Jahre
Jahre
Honsberg
Club 15
Team of staff members
15 years and more.
Appreciation & respect
340
Communication basics
Basic
Complete range catalogue
344 pages
Price list
40 pages
Range summary,
company profile
31 pages
Focus
Application-related device
descriptions 12 to 24 pages
Omni Flex
Product catalogues
Integrated systems
Omni 40 pages
Flex 16 pages
Digital
Updated product descriptions, new
products and applications available as
a CD or via the Internet under
www.honsberg.com
Contact
Informative magazine for
customers and friends of
the company. Is distributed
at irregular intervals.
Doku
All catalogues plus
price information
341
Basic
Data + details
length
1 feet
1 feet
1 inch
1 inch
1 km
1 km
1 km
1m
1m
1m
1m
1 mm
1 mm
1 naut.mile
1 stat. mile
1 yard
= 0.304799 m
=
12 inch
= 0.08333 feet
= 25.39996 mm
=
1000 m
= 0.53960 naut.mile
= 0.62140 stat. mile
= 3.28085 feet
=
0.001 km
=
1000 mm
= 1 .09362 yard
= 0.03937 inch
=
0.001 m
=
1.853 km
=
1.609 km
= 0.91440 km
speed
1 ft/s
1 ft/s
1 ft/s
1 knot
1 knot
1 knot
1 m/s
1 m/s
1 m/s
1 mile/h
1 mile/h
1 mile/h
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
0.06
0.21997
0.26420
16.6667
4.546
3.785
0.59252
0.30480
0.68595
1.15767
1.68770
0.51441
3.28084
1.94397
2.25048
1.45784
0.86380
0.44435
m3/h
UK gal/min
US gal/min
l/min
l/min
l/min
knot
m/s
mile/h
mile/h
ft/s
m/s
ft/s
knot
mile/h
ft/s
knot
m/s
pressure
1 bar
1 bar
1 N/m2
1 Pa
1 Pa
1 psi
=
=
=
=
=
=
100000
14.504
1
0.00001
1
0.069
Pa
psi
Pa
bar
N/m2
bar
volume
1 cm3
1 dm3
1 dm3
1 ft3
1 ft3
1 ft3
1 ft3
1 ft3
1l
1l
1l
1l
1 m3
1 m3
1 UK gal
1 UK gal
1 US gal
1 US gal
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
1000
1000
1
1728
6.2282
7.4797
0.02832
28.3169
1
0.03531
0.21995
0.26414
1000
35.3146
0.16056
4.54656
0.1337
3.78583
mm3
cm3
l
in3
UK gal
US gal
m3
l
dm3
ft3
UK gal
US gal
dm3
ft3
ft3
l
ft3
l
temperature
temperature F - 32
temperature C =
1.8
temperature F = temperature C x 1.8 + 32
weight
0.1 kg
0.2 kg
0.5 kg
1.0 kg
2.0 kg
5.0 kg
=
3.53
=
7.05
= 17.64
= 35.27
= 70.54
= 176.35
oz
oz
oz
oz
oz
oz
= O
= O
= 1
= 2
= 4
= 11
lb
lb
Ib
lb
lb
Ib
3
7
1
3
6
0
oz
oz
oz
oz
oz
oz
Viscosity
=
=
=
=
=
=
flow
1 l/min
1 l/min
1 l/min
1 m3/h
1 UK gal/min
1 US gal/min
mm2/s
Rl sec
sec
S. U.
sec
1,0
1,5
2,0
2,5
3,0
3,5
4,0
4,5
5,0
5,5
6,0
6,5
7,0
8,0
10,0
11,0
13,0
15,0
17,0
20,0
22,0
25,0
30,0
35,0
40,0
45,0
50,0
56,0
60,0
70,0
80,0
90,0
100,0
114,0
150,0
227,4
303,2
379,0
400,0
1080,0
2160,0
8460,0
1,0
1,06
1,12
1,17
1,22
1,26
1,3
1,35
1,4
1,44
1,48
1,52
1,56
1,65
1,83
1,93
2,12
2,32
2,55
2,9
3,1
3,45
4,1
4,7
5,35
6,0
6,65
7,4
7,9
9,24
10,56
11,88
13,2
15
19,8
30
40
50
52,8
142,5
285
1140
28,5
30
31
32
33
34,5
35,5
37
38
39,5
41
42
43,5
46
52
55
61
68
75
86
93
105
125
144
164
185
205
229
245
283,5
324
364,5
405
460,5
611
921
1228
1535
1620
4435
8870
35480
32,6
34,4
36
37,6
39,1
40,7
42,3
43,9
45,5
47,1
48,7
52
58,8
62,3
69,6
77,2
85,1
97,5
106
118,9
140,9
163,2
185,7
208,4
231,4
259
277,4
323,4
369,6
415,8
462
526,7
701
1053,3
1404,4
1755,5
1848
5000
10000
40000
342
Data + details
materials
stainless steel
No.
materials
VA
AISI
BS
1.4122
1.4301
1.4305
1.4310
1.4404
1.4408
1.4436
1.4462
1.4541
X 35 CrMo 17
X 5 CrNi 18 10
X 10 CrNiS 18 9
X 12 CrNi 17 7
X 2 CrNiMo 17 12
G-X 6 CrNiMo 18 10
X 5 CrNiMo 17 13
X 2 CrNiMoN 22 5
X 6 CrNiTi 18 11
2
2
2
2
4
4
2
304
303
301
316L
CF-8M
316
2205
321
304S15
303S21
316S12
316S16
321 S1 2
brass
No.
materials
Ms
DIN-EN
2.0230
2.0321
2.0360
2.0380
2.0402
CuZn1O
CuZn37
CuZn40
CuZn39Pb2
CuZn40Pb2
Ms90
Ms63
Ms60
Ms59
Ms58
CW
CW
CW
CW
CW
cast iron
No.
materials
0.6026
GG-25
bronze
No.
materials
Rg
2.1096.01
2.1093.01
G-CuSn5ZnPb
G-CuSn6ZnNi
Rg5
Rg6
cast steel
No.
materials
GP
1.0619 N
GSC-25
GP 240 GH
501
508
509
612
617
L
L
L
N
N
plastic
ABS
PA
PC
POM
PP
PS
PTFE
PVC
PVDF
acrylicnitrile/butadiene/styrene
polyamide
polycarbonat
polyoxymethylene
polypropylen
polystorol
polytetrafluorineethylene (teflon)
polyvinyl chloride
polyvinylidenfluoride
elast
DIN/ISO
ATSM
marking
commercial name
CR
EPDM
FPM
NBR
CR
EPDM
FKM
NBR
chloroprene-caoutchouc
ethylene-propylene-diene-caoutchouc
fluorine-caoutchouc
acrylicnitrile-butadiene-caoutchouc
Basic
flow
level
temperature
pressure
344
Index
AR
BL
CF
CM2K
CRG
CWE
EDP1
EEFK
EEV
EEZ
EFFF
EFFI
EFFS
EFFU
EFK2
EFKM
EFKP
EFKS
ELC
EPS
EPS1
ESA1
ESK2
ESK3
ETS
ETSD
FF
FH
FIS
FK
FL
Flex
Flex-FIN
FM
FQ
FR
FW1
FW3
FX
G
GIA
GK
GKL
GR
HD1K
HD2K
HE
HM1K
HR1MV
HV
KH
KM
LC
MD
MF-003
MF-007
MH
96
233
220
146
148
260
292
215
318
319
316
315
314
317
210
208
208
215
320
288
290
319
320
320
274
276
20
226
217
230
330
297
212
22
231
167
56
58
59
24
320
118
121
102
61
64
323
67
70
183
238
239
254
286
73
74
88
MI
MMF
MP
MR
MR1K
MSR
MW3
MWI
MXM
MXO
MXR
NA
NB
NBS
NG
NH1
NJ
NJV
NL
NM
NMS
NO
NR
NW1
NW3
Omni
ON
OT
OW
PD
PH
PI
PM
PO
PS
RA
RH
RM
RO
RR.-032
RRF
RRH-010/025
RRI-010/025
RRO-010/025
RRT
RRT1
RS
RT
RVM
RW
RWI
SB
SK
TF1
TR
TS
TX
96
124
40
75
77
319
258
261
37
37
36
264
264
263
262
81
82
85
265
248
249
94
252
259
258
297
227
96
228
47
282
284
282
166
287
170
172
168
184
180
185
176
174
178
187
188
167
190
79
256
257
250
232
272
273
328
38
TZ1-...E
TZ1-F
TZ1-GK
TZ1-GR
UB1
UI
UK-020
UK-040
UK-044
UK-047
UK-048
UK-050
UM3K-GK
UM3K-GM
UM3K-VK
UM3K-VM
UR1-GK
UR1-GM
UR1-VK
UR1-VM
UR2-GK
UR2-GM
UR2-VK
UR2-VM
UR3K-GK
UR3K-GM
UR3K-VK
UR3K-VM
UZ
VB
VC
VD-F
VD-GK
VD-GR
VDO
VF
VHO
VHZ
VI
VL
VM-E
VM-F
VM-GK
VM-GR
VO
VP
WE
WK
WO1
WP
WR1
WT
XF
YR
ZE
ZV
152
48
44
42
144
141
106
108
110
112
114
116
136
136
138
138
140
140
142
142
140
140
142
142
132
132
134
134
154
327
329
47
28
26
34
90
196
192
48
104
150
47
32
30
92
285
319
240
229
241
169
242
157
149
325
324
Flow
Level
Temperature
Pressure
Filtration
Basic
Pressure Filtration
Main Catalogue
Agent